]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
gdb: remove some uses of LA_PRINT_STRING
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
b3adc24a 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
b3adc24a 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
b3adc24a 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
abf874aa
CL
464@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474@smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493@end smallexample
494
495This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500This option enables warnings when
501@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504output region.
505
252b5132
RH
506@cindex entry point, from command line
507@kindex -e @var{entry}
508@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 509@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
510@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
b58f81ae
DJ
519@kindex --exclude-libs
520@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 522exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
523@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528be treated as hidden.
529
e1c37eb5
DK
530@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541regardless of this option.
542
252b5132
RH
543@cindex dynamic symbol table
544@kindex -E
545@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 546@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
547@item -E
548@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
549@itemx --no-export-dynamic
550When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
559
560If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563linking the program itself.
564
55255dae 565You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 566be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 567See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 568
8b747e1a
DK
569Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
37a141bf
FS
573@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574@cindex export dynamic symbol
575@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585@cindex export dynamic symbol list
586@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
36f63dca 591@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
592@cindex big-endian objects
593@cindex endianness
594@kindex -EB
595@item -EB
596Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598@cindex little-endian objects
599@kindex -EL
600@item -EL
601Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 602@end ifclear
252b5132 603
2509a395
SL
604@kindex -f @var{name}
605@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606@item -f @var{name}
607@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
608When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 621machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
622
623This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
2509a395
SL
626@kindex -F @var{name}
627@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 628@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 629@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
630When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641@var{name}.
642
ff5dcc92 643Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 644toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
645object files.
646@ifclear SingleFormat
647The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 648@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 649@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
650environment variable.
651@end ifclear
652The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 654
3dbf70a2 655@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
656@kindex -fini=@var{name}
657@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
658When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661the function to call.
662
252b5132
RH
663@kindex -g
664@item -g
665Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
2509a395
SL
667@kindex -G @var{value}
668@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 669@cindex object size
2509a395 670@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
671@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 674MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
675sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 678@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 679@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 680@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
681@itemx -soname=@var{name}
682When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
687
688@kindex -i
689@cindex incremental link
690@item -i
691Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
3dbf70a2 693@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
694@kindex -init=@var{name}
695@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
696When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699function to call.
700
252b5132 701@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 702@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 703@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 704@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
705@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 709will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 710will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 711
ff5dcc92 712On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
713files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
720
721The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
ff5dcc92 728See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
729archives multiple times.
730
731You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733@ifset GENERIC
734This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 735if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
736behaviour of the AIX linker.
737@end ifset
738
739@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 740@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 741@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 742@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 743@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
744Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
746option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 749@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
750order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752option is specified.
252b5132 753
3aa2d05a
NC
754If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 757
252b5132
RH
758@ifset UsesEnvVars
759The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 760@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
761some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762@end ifset
763
764The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768@cindex emulation
769@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 770@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
771Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778configured.
779
780@cindex link map
781@kindex -M
782@kindex --print-map
783@item -M
784@itemx --print-map
785Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786information about the link, including the following:
787
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
3b83e13a 790Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
791@item
792How common symbols are allocated.
793@item
794All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
796@item
797The values assigned to symbols.
798
799Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805linker script containing:
806
807@smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811@end smallexample
812
813will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814option is used:
815
816@smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820@end smallexample
821
822See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823scripts.
d2ef37eb 824
06ddcada
AM
825@item
826How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 827
06ddcada
AM
828When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
831
832@smallexample
833Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834@end smallexample
835
06ddcada 836This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
837merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840@smallexample
06ddcada 841Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
842@end smallexample
843
06ddcada 844This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
845when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
847@end itemize
848
035801ce
FS
849@cindex link map discarded
850@kindex --print-map-discarded
851@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852@item --print-map-discarded
853@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
252b5132
RH
857@kindex -n
858@cindex read-only text
859@cindex NMAGIC
860@kindex --nmagic
861@item -n
862@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
863Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
866
867@kindex -N
868@kindex --omagic
869@cindex read/write from cmd line
870@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 871@item -N
252b5132
RH
872@itemx --omagic
873Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
874not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
876mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
879
880@kindex --no-omagic
881@cindex OMAGIC
882@item --no-omagic
883This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
887
888@kindex -o @var{output}
889@kindex --output=@var{output}
890@cindex naming the output file
891@item -o @var{output}
892@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 893Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
894option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
f37b21b4
RM
897@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898@cindex dependency file
899@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
252b5132
RH
912@kindex -O @var{level}
913@cindex generating optimized output
914@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 915If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 916the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
917should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 922
387dd777
DP
923@kindex -plugin @var{name}
924@item -plugin @var{name}
925Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929wish.
930
931Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 935copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 936based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 937just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 938
26278bb8
UD
939@kindex --push-state
940@cindex push state governing input file handling
941@item --push-state
942The @option{--push-state} allows to preserve the current state of the
943flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956something as follows:
957
958@smallexample
959-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960@end smallexample
961
962@kindex --pop-state
963@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 964@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
965Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966flags governing input file handling.
967
a712da20
NC
968@kindex -q
969@kindex --emit-relocs
970@cindex retain relocations in final executable
971@item -q
972@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 973Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
974Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976in larger executables.
977
dbab7a7b
NC
978This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
4f471f39
RS
980@kindex --force-dynamic
981@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982@item --force-dynamic
983Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984to VxWorks targets.
985
252b5132
RH
986@cindex partial link
987@cindex relocatable output
988@kindex -r
1049f94e 989@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 990@item -r
1049f94e 991@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 992Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 993turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
994linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 997@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
998If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
62bf86b4
HPN
1002When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006with input files in other formats at all.
1007
252b5132
RH
1008This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010@kindex -R @var{file}
1011@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012@cindex symbol-only input
1013@item -R @var{filename}
1014@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
ff5dcc92 1020For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1021followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1022the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1023
1024@kindex -s
1025@kindex --strip-all
1026@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1027@item -s
252b5132
RH
1028@itemx --strip-all
1029Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031@kindex -S
1032@kindex --strip-debug
1033@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1034@item -S
252b5132
RH
1035@itemx --strip-debug
1036Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
a70f34c0
NC
1038@kindex --strip-discarded
1039@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040@item --strip-discarded
1041@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043Enabled by default.
1044
252b5132
RH
1045@kindex -t
1046@kindex --trace
1047@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1048@item -t
252b5132 1049@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1050Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1055
1056@kindex -T @var{script}
1057@kindex --script=@var{script}
1058@cindex script files
1059@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1062@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1063@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1064output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067options accumulate.
252b5132 1068
14be8564
L
1069@kindex -dT @var{script}
1070@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071@cindex script files
1072@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083@samp{gcc}).
1084
252b5132
RH
1085@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087@cindex undefined symbol
1088@item -u @var{symbol}
1089@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
0a618243
AB
1096If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099instead.
1100
1101@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102@cindex symbols, require defined
1103@cindex defined symbol
1104@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
252b5132
RH
1112@kindex -Ur
1113@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1114@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1115For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1117turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1118@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122@samp{-r} for the others.
1123
c005eb9e
AB
1124@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125@cindex orphan sections
1126@cindex sections, orphan
1127@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133@table @code
1134@item place
1135Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1137@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1138
1139@item discard
1140All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143@item warn
1144The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145issue a warning.
1146
1147@item error
1148The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149@end table
1150
1151The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
577a0623
AM
1153@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1162
252b5132
RH
1163@kindex -v
1164@kindex -V
1165@kindex --version
1166@cindex version
1167@item -v
1168@itemx --version
1169@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1170Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1171lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173@kindex -x
1174@kindex --discard-all
1175@cindex deleting local symbols
1176@item -x
1177@itemx --discard-all
1178Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180@kindex -X
1181@kindex --discard-locals
1182@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1183@item -X
252b5132 1184@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1185Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1188
1189@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191@cindex symbol tracing
1192@item -y @var{symbol}
1193@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201@kindex -Y @var{path}
1202@item -Y @var{path}
1203Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1208The recognized keywords are:
1209@table @samp
1210
e6e2dfbd
AM
1211@item bndplt
1212Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
233a0083
L
1226@item cet-report=none
1227@itemx cet-report=warning
1228@itemx cet-report=error
1229Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
cd6d6c15 1241@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1242@itemx nocombreloc
1243Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1245
b8871f35 1246@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1247@itemx nocommon
1248Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1255
cd6d6c15 1256@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1257Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1260
e6e2dfbd
AM
1261@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269these options.
1270
6aa29e7b
JJ
1271@item execstack
1272Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
b039ef04
L
1274@item global
1275This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
93ab9c0d
NC
1279@item globalaudit
1280This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1284the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1285all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1286
e6e2dfbd
AM
1287@item ibtplt
1288Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
8df93cb5 1291@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1292Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
cd6d6c15
NC
1296@item initfirst
1297This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1298It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1299before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1300the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1301the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1302objects.
1303
1304@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1305Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1306so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1307libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1308
c3805e4c
VDM
1309@item unique
1310@itemx nounique
1311When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1312object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1313and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1314primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1315al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1316of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1317and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1318
5fa222e4
AM
1319@item lazy
1320When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1321dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1322the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1323Lazy binding is the default.
1324
cd6d6c15 1325@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1326Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1327
e6e2dfbd
AM
1328@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1329Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1330
e6e2dfbd
AM
1331@item muldefs
1332Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1333
cd6d6c15 1334@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1335Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1336defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1337
1338@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1339Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1340should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1341
1342@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1343Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1344
1345@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1346Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1347
1348@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1349Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1350
6aa29e7b
JJ
1351@item noexecstack
1352Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1353
e6e2dfbd
AM
1354@item noextern-protected-data
1355Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1356library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1357used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1358generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1359module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1360i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1361
e6e2dfbd
AM
1362@item noreloc-overflow
1363Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1364relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1365overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1366
cd6d6c15
NC
1367@item now
1368When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1369dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1370when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1371function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1372called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1373
1374@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1375Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1376
6aa29e7b 1377@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1378@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1379Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1380specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1381relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1382than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1383Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1384
47acac12
L
1385@item separate-code
1386@itemx noseparate-code
1387Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1388specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1389be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1390code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1391
496afd17
L
1392@item unique-symbol
1393@itemx nounique-symbol
1394Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1395".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1396is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1397
e6e2dfbd
AM
1398@item shstk
1399Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1400to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1401Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1402
04c3a755 1403@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1404Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1405Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1406@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1407
cae64165
RM
1408@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1409@cindex visibility
1410@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1411Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1412@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1413Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1414@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1415start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1416compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1417recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1418programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1419between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1420
e6e2dfbd
AM
1421@item text
1422@itemx notext
1423@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1424Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1425or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1426report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1427
97a232d7
NC
1428@item undefs
1429Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1430either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1431This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1432
b0ab0693 1433@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1434@item x86-64-v2
1435@item x86-64-v3
1436@itemx x86-64-v4
1437Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1438@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1439@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1440@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1441@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1442Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1443
cd6d6c15
NC
1444@end table
1445
ece2d90e 1446Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1447
1448@kindex -(
1449@cindex groups of archives
1450@item -( @var{archives} -)
1451@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1452The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1453either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1454
1455The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1456references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1457the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1458archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1459object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1460would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1461they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1462resolved.
1463
1464Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1465it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1466more archives.
1467
69da35b5
NC
1468@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1469@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1470@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1471@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1472Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1473recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1474and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1475the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1476behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1477so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1478restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1479
4a43e768
AM
1480@kindex --as-needed
1481@kindex --no-as-needed
1482@item --as-needed
1483@itemx --no-as-needed
1484This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1485on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1486the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1487on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1488needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1489emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1490non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1491the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1492non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1493Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1494the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1495needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1496from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1497
e56f61be
L
1498@kindex --add-needed
1499@kindex --no-add-needed
1500@item --add-needed
1501@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1502These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1503their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1504options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1505and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1506
252b5132
RH
1507@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1508@item -assert @var{keyword}
1509This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1510
1511@kindex -Bdynamic
1512@kindex -dy
1513@kindex -call_shared
1514@item -Bdynamic
1515@itemx -dy
1516@itemx -call_shared
1517Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1518for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1519default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1520for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1521multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1522@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1523
a1ab1d2a
UD
1524@kindex -Bgroup
1525@item -Bgroup
1526Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1527section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1528object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1529@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1530only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1531
252b5132
RH
1532@kindex -Bstatic
1533@kindex -dn
1534@kindex -non_shared
1535@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1536@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1537@itemx -dn
1538@itemx -non_shared
1539@itemx -static
1540Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1541platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1542variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1543may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1544library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1545option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1546option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1547shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1548references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1549libraries.
252b5132
RH
1550
1551@kindex -Bsymbolic
1552@item -Bsymbolic
1553When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1554definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1555for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1556within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1557platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1558
40b36307
L
1559@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1560@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1561When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1562symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1563This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1564libraries.
40b36307 1565
55255dae
L
1566@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1567@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1568Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1569typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1570global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1571within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1572to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1573in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1574which support shared libraries.
1575
1576The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1577scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1578
40b36307
L
1579@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1580@item --dynamic-list-data
1581Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1582
1583@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1584@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1585Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1586is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1587
0b8a70d9
L
1588@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1589@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1590Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1591
252b5132
RH
1592@kindex --check-sections
1593@kindex --no-check-sections
1594@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1595@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1596Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1597been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1598perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1599suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1600allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1601restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1602Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1603force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1604option.
252b5132 1605
ddbb8a31
NC
1606@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1607@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1608@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1609@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1610This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1611by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1612command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1613output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1614input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1615specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1616follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1617behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1618
1619This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1620libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1621mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1622their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1623required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1624the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1625dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1626symbols.
1627
252b5132
RH
1628@cindex cross reference table
1629@kindex --cref
1630@item --cref
1631Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1632generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1633Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1634
1635The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1636easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1637sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1638symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1639definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1640where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1641symbol are listed.
252b5132 1642
5dba6f05
NA
1643@cindex ctf variables
1644@kindex --ctf-variables
1645@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1646@item --ctf-variables
1647@item --no-ctf-variables
1648The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1649types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1650table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1651conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1652usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1653@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1654The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1655
1656@cindex ctf type sharing
1657@kindex --ctf-share-types
1658@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1659Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1660
1661@table @samp
1662@item share-unconflicted
1663Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1664where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1665translation unit. This is the default.
1666
1667@item share-duplicated
1668Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1669dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1670dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1671always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1672larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1673large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1674consumer at runtime.
1675@end table
1676
4818e05f
AM
1677@cindex common allocation
1678@kindex --no-define-common
1679@item --no-define-common
1680This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1681The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1682@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1683
1684The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1685the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1686of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1687forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1688Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1689from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1690This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1691and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1692duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1693paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1694
7bdf4127
AB
1695@cindex group allocation in linker script
1696@cindex section groups
1697@cindex COMDAT
1698@kindex --force-group-allocation
1699@item --force-group-allocation
1700This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1701normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1702default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1703change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1704command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1705effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1706
252b5132 1707@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1708@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1709@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1710Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1711address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1712times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1713limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1714context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1715symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1716constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1717using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1718@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1719equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1720
54874444
AB
1721The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1722in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1723symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1724placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1725the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1726consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1727@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1728you are trying to achieve.
1729
252b5132 1730@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1731@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1732@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1733@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1734@itemx --no-demangle
1735These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1736and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1737present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1738underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1739mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1740different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1741to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1742demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1743is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1744
1745@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1746@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1747@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1748@item -I@var{file}
1749@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1750Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1751generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1752linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1753doing.
1754
9b8b325a
RF
1755@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1756@item --no-dynamic-linker
1757When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1758linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1759executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1760entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1761
a70f34c0
NC
1762@kindex --embedded-relocs
1763@item --embedded-relocs
1764This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1765that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1766is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1767targets.
1768
3f0a5f17
ME
1769@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1770@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1771Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1772in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1773
7ce691ae 1774@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1775@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1776@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1777@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1778Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1779with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1780
252b5132
RH
1781@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1782@item --force-exe-suffix
1783Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1784
1785If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1786@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1787the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1788option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1789Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1790it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1791
1792@kindex --gc-sections
1793@kindex --no-gc-sections
1794@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1795@item --gc-sections
1796@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1797Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1798targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1799performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1800@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1801collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1802implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1803
d5465ba2
AM
1804@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1805examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1806symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1807command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1808referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1809libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1810referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1811the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1812relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1813@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1814
ac69cbc6 1815This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1816@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1817specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1818@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1819command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1820
99fabbc9
JL
1821As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1822@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1823
c17d87de
NC
1824@kindex --print-gc-sections
1825@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1826@cindex garbage collection
1827@item --print-gc-sections
1828@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1829List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1830printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1831collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1832default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1833be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1834line.
1835
22185505 1836@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1837@cindex garbage collection
1838@item --gc-keep-exported
1839When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1840collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1841default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1842executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1843collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1844Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1845it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1846ELF format targets.
1847
30824704
RM
1848@kindex --print-output-format
1849@cindex output format
1850@item --print-output-format
1851Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1852other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1853in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1854
3604cb1f
TG
1855@kindex --print-memory-usage
1856@cindex memory usage
1857@item --print-memory-usage
1858Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1859the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1860quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1861headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1862parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1863
1864@smallexample
1865Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1866 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1867 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1868@end smallexample
1869
252b5132
RH
1870@cindex help
1871@cindex usage
1872@kindex --help
1873@item --help
1874Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1875
ea20a7da
CC
1876@kindex --target-help
1877@item --target-help
a094d01f 1878Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1879
2509a395
SL
1880@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1881@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1882Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
1883@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1884@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1885
1886Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1887written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1888inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1889file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1890@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1891output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1892@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1893
1894@smallexample
1895 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1896 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1897 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1898 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1899 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1900 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1901 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
1902 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
1903 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
1904 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
1905@end smallexample
1906
1907It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
1908
1909If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
1910operation.
252b5132
RH
1911
1912@cindex memory usage
1913@kindex --no-keep-memory
1914@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
1915@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1916symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 1917instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 1918necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
1919while linking a large executable.
1920
1921@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1922@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 1923@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 1924@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1925@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
1926Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1927is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1928The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1929behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 1930libraries being linked in.
252b5132 1931
97a232d7
NC
1932The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
1933
aa713662
L
1934@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
1935@kindex -z muldefs
1936@item --allow-multiple-definition
1937@itemx -z muldefs
1938Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
1939report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
1940first definition will be used.
1941
b79e8c78 1942@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1943@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 1944@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1945@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 1946Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
1947This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
1948determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
1949shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
1950how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
1951
903249d7
NC
1952The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
1953referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
1954an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
1955a shared library.
1956
1957The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
1958libraries specified at link time are that:
1959
1960@itemize @bullet
1961@item
1962A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
1963that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
1964resolvable at load time.
1965@item
1966There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
1967symbols in shared libraries are normal.
1968
1969The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
1970select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
1971architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
1972appropriate memset function.
1973@end itemize
b79e8c78 1974
23ae20f5
NC
1975@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
1976@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
1977If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
1978@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
1979only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
1980libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
93cf38c0
NC
1981``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
1982undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
1983will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
1984might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
1985error message will be displayed.
1986
1987The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
1988switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
1989
31941635
L
1990@kindex --no-undefined-version
1991@item --no-undefined-version
1992Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
1993it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
1994will be issued instead.
1995
3e3b46e5
PB
1996@kindex --default-symver
1997@item --default-symver
1998Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
1999exported symbols.
2000
2001@kindex --default-imported-symver
2002@item --default-imported-symver
2003Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2004imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2005
252b5132
RH
2006@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2007@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2008Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2009files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2010been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2011This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2012errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2013have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2014inappropriate.
2015
fe7929ce
AM
2016@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2017@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2018Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2019library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2020
252b5132
RH
2021@kindex --no-whole-archive
2022@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2023Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2024archive files.
2025
2026@cindex output file after errors
2027@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2028@item --noinhibit-exec
2029Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2030Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2031errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2032when it issues any error whatsoever.
2033
0a9c1c8e
CD
2034@kindex -nostdlib
2035@item -nostdlib
2036Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2037command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2038(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2039
252b5132 2040@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2041@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2042@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2043@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2044file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2045@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2046object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2047object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2048should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2049usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2050name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2051list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2052command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2053this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2054@end ifclear
2055
76359541
TP
2056@kindex --out-implib
2057@item --out-implib @var{file}
2058Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2059the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2060library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2061may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2062behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2063step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2064the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2065
36af4a4e
JJ
2066@kindex -pie
2067@kindex --pic-executable
2068@item -pie
2069@itemx --pic-executable
2070@cindex position independent executables
2071Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2072ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2073libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2074address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2075normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2076defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2077
252b5132
RH
2078@kindex -qmagic
2079@item -qmagic
2080This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2081
2082@kindex -Qy
2083@item -Qy
2084This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2085
2086@kindex --relax
2087@cindex synthesizing linker
2088@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2089@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2090@item --relax
28d5f677 2091@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2092An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2093@ifset GENERIC
2094This option is only supported on a few targets.
2095@end ifset
2096@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2097@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2098@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2099@ifset XTENSA
2100@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2101@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2102@ifset M68HC11
2103@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2104@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2105@ifset NIOSII
2106@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2107@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2108@ifset POWERPC
2109@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2110@end ifset
252b5132 2111
ccd9fae5 2112On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2113global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2114addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2115synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2116instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2117
2118On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2119debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2120@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2121This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2122family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2123@end ifset
2124
ccd9fae5
NC
2125On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2126@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2127
ccd9fae5
NC
2128On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2129and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2130
252b5132
RH
2131@cindex retaining specified symbols
2132@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2133@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2134@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2135@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2136Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2137discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2138symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2139@ifset GENERIC
2140(such as VxWorks)
2141@end ifset
2142where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2143run-time memory.
2144
2145@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2146or symbols needed for relocations.
2147
2148You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2149line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2150
2151@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2152@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2153@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2154@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2155Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2156linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2157arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2158them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2159
2160The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2161are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2162description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2163in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2164have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2165
2166If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2167contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2168is defined.
252b5132 2169
ff5dcc92 2170The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2171SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2172@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2173runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2174options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2175gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2176file systems.
252b5132 2177
ff5dcc92 2178For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2179followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2180the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2181@end ifset
2182
2183@ifset GENERIC
2184@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2185@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2186@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2187When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2188happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2189of the input files.
2190
2191When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2192non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2193shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2194explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2195specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2196@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2197either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2198appearing multiple times.
2199
e680a6b6
NC
2200The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2201directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2202containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2203and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
220464-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2205
2206The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2207@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2208supported.
2209
28c309a2
NC
2210This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2211that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2212is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2213runtime linker would do.
2214
252b5132 2215The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2216libraries:
d8e4137b 2217
252b5132
RH
2218@enumerate
2219@item
ff5dcc92 2220Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2221@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2222Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2223between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2224specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2225used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2226at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2227by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2228the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2229@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2230On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2231@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2232environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2233@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2234On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2235directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2236@item
a1b8d843 2237For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2238variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2239@item
ec4eb78a
L
2240For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2241@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2242libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2243@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2244@item
252b5132
RH
2245The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2246@item
d8e4137b
NC
2247For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2248exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2249to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2250defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2251configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2252@item
2253For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2254the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2255header file.
2256@item
2257Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2258linker script being used.
252b5132
RH
2259@end enumerate
2260
2261If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2262warning and continue with the link.
2263@end ifset
2264
2265@kindex -shared
2266@kindex -Bshareable
2267@item -shared
2268@itemx -Bshareable
2269@cindex shared libraries
2270Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2271and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2272shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2273undefined symbols in the link.
2274
252b5132 2275@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2276@item --sort-common
2277@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2278@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2279This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2280ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2281sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2282eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2283between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2284specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2285
2509a395
SL
2286@kindex --sort-section=name
2287@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2288This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2289patterns in the linker script.
2290
2509a395
SL
2291@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2292@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2293This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2294patterns in the linker script.
2295
a70f34c0
NC
2296@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2297@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2298This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2299.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2300post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2301
252b5132 2302@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2303@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2304Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2305each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2306size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2307
2308@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2309@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2310Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2311output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2312This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2313certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2314cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2315that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2316support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2317input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2318more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2319many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2320
2321@kindex --stats
2322@item --stats
2323Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2324as execution time and memory usage.
2325
2509a395 2326@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2327@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2328Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2329configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2330that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2331
a70f34c0
NC
2332@kindex --task-link
2333@item --task-link
2334This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2335file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2336
252b5132
RH
2337@kindex --traditional-format
2338@cindex traditional format
2339@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2340For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2341the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2342use the traditional format instead.
2343
2344@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2345For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2346symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2347full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2348@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2349trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2350combine duplicate entries.
2351
2509a395
SL
2352@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2353@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2354Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2355address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2356times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2357line.
2358@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2359for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2360@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2361should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2362sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2363
2509a395
SL
2364@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2365@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2366@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2367@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2368@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2369@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2370@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2371Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2372@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2373
2509a395
SL
2374@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2375@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2376@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2377When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2378byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2379
9d5777a3
RM
2380@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2381@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2382@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2383When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2384the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2385text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2386
0d705e9f
AM
2387@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2388@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2389@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2390When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2391model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2392
560e09e9
NC
2393@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2394@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2395Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2396values for @samp{method}:
2397
2398@table @samp
2399@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2400Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2401
2402@item report-all
da8bce14 2403Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2404
2405@item ignore-in-object-files
2406Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2407ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2408
2409@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2410Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2411ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2412when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2413libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2414command line.
2415@end table
2416
2417The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2418by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2419
2420Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2421unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2422can change this to a warning.
2423
1715a13c
L
2424@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2425@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2426@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2427@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2428Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2429supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2430the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2431argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2432
2433@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2434@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2435@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2436Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2437used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2438about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2439is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2440see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2441use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2442symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2443@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2444
7ce691ae 2445@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2446@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2447@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2448@item --warn-common
2449Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2450a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2451but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2452you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2453Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2454warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2455
2456There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2457
2458@table @samp
2459@item int i = 1;
2460A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2461file.
2462
2463@item extern int i;
2464An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2465There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2466variable somewhere.
2467
2468@item int i;
2469A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2470variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2471The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2472single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2473size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2474a definition of the same variable.
2475@end table
2476
2477The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2478Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2479just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2480encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2481a common symbol.
2482
2483@enumerate
2484@item
2485Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2486definition for the symbol.
2487@smallexample
2488@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2489 overridden by definition
2490@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2491@end smallexample
2492
2493@item
2494Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2495the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2496except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2497@smallexample
2498@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2499 overriding common
2500@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2501@end smallexample
2502
2503@item
2504Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2505@smallexample
2506@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2507 of `@var{symbol}'
2508@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2509@end smallexample
2510
2511@item
2512Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2513@smallexample
2514@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2515 overridden by larger common
2516@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2517@end smallexample
2518
2519@item
2520Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2521the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2522encountered in a different order.
2523@smallexample
2524@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2525 overriding smaller common
2526@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2527@end smallexample
2528@end enumerate
2529
2530@kindex --warn-constructors
2531@item --warn-constructors
2532Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2533object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2534detect the use of global constructors.
2535
2536@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2537@item --warn-multiple-gp
2538Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2539This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2540Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2541section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2542of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2543base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2544base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2545bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2546large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2547values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2548option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2549
2550@kindex --warn-once
2551@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2552@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2553@item --warn-once
2554Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2555which refers to it.
2556
2557@kindex --warn-section-align
2558@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2559@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2560@item --warn-section-align
2561Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2562alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2563The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2564is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2565the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2566
a6dbf402
L
2567@kindex --warn-textrel
2568@item --warn-textrel
2569Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2570or shared object.
8fdd7217 2571
a0c402a5
L
2572@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2573@item --warn-alternate-em
2574Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2575
560e09e9
NC
2576@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2577@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2578If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2579@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2580This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2581
2582@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2583@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2584This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2585it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2586
252b5132
RH
2587@kindex --whole-archive
2588@cindex including an entire archive
2589@item --whole-archive
2590For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2591@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2592in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2593files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2594library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2595library. This option may be used more than once.
2596
7ec229ce 2597Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2598about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2599Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2600list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2601your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2602
2509a395
SL
2603@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2604@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2605Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2606@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2607undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2608@var{symbol}.
2609
2610This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2611wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2612wishes to call the system function, it should call
2613@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2614
2615Here is a trivial example:
2616
2617@smallexample
2618void *
cc2f008e 2619__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2620@{
cc2f008e 2621 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2622 return __real_malloc (c);
2623@}
2624@end smallexample
2625
ff5dcc92 2626If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2627all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2628instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2629call the real @code{malloc} function.
2630
2631You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2632links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2633you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2634file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2635call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2636
4ea904ed
SH
2637Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2638internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2639@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2640@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2641
2642@smallexample
2643int
2644f (void)
2645@{
2646 return 123;
2647@}
2648
2649int
2650g (void)
2651@{
2652 return f();
2653@}
2654@end smallexample
2655
6aa29e7b 2656@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2657@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2658@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2659@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2660Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2661(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2662section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2663
e41b3a13
JJ
2664@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2665@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2666Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2667generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2668if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2669
6c1439be
L
2670@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2671@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2672@item --enable-new-dtags
2673@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2674This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2675systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2676@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2677and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2678If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2679created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2680those options are only available for ELF systems.
2681
2d643429 2682@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2683@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2684Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2685close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2686time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2687increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2688value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2689
fdc90cb4
JJ
2690@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2691@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2692Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2693@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2694new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2695the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2696hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2697but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2698
0ce398f1
L
2699@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2700@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2701@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2702@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2703@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2704@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2705@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2706@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2707On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2708compressed using zlib.
2709
2710@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2711sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2712DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2713instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2714also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2715sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2716
2717The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2718@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2719
2720Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2721sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2722for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2723uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2724
2725The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2726involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2727default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2728@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2729
35835446
JR
2730@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2731@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2732This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2733linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2734for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2735about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2736
4f9c04f7 2737Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 27381021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2739run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2740has been used.
2741
2742The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2743enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2744
c0065db7
RM
2745@kindex --build-id
2746@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2747@item --build-id
2748@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2749Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2750or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2751unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2752@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2753@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2754@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2755the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2756string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2757@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2758is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2759
2760The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2761that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2762unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2763to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2764file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2765string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2766
2767Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2768@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2769@end table
2770
0285c67d
NC
2771@c man end
2772
36f63dca 2773@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2774
0285c67d
NC
2775@c man begin OPTIONS
2776
ff5dcc92 2777The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2778the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2779normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2780use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2781@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2782like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2783symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2784object file).
2785
2786In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2787support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2788PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2789values by either a space or an equals sign.
2790
ff5dcc92 2791@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2792
2793@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2794@item --add-stdcall-alias
2795If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2796as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2797[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2798
2799@kindex --base-file
2800@item --base-file @var{file}
2801Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2802addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2803@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2804[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2805
2806@kindex --dll
2807@item --dll
2808Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2809@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2810file.
bb10df36 2811[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2812
88183869
DK
2813@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2814@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2815@item --enable-long-section-names
2816@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2817The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2818the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2819for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2820fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2821to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2822allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2823disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2824generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2825as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2826with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2827GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2828information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2829option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2830section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2831when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2832image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2833[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2834
252b5132
RH
2835@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2836@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2837@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2838@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2839If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2840do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2841only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2842resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2843undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2844@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2845to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2846warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2847import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2848to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2849feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2850@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2851mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2852[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2853
522f09cd
KT
2854@kindex --leading-underscore
2855@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2856@item --leading-underscore
2857@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2858For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2859in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2860disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2861
252b5132
RH
2862@cindex DLLs, creating
2863@kindex --export-all-symbols
2864@item --export-all-symbols
2865If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2866be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2867otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2868explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2869attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2870option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2871@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2872@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2873exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2874re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2875such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2876@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
2877@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2878Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2879not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 2880extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 2881(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 2882These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 2883@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 2884@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 2885@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 2886@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 2887[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2888
2889@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 2890@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
2891Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2892exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 2893[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2894
2927aaca
NC
2895@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2896@item --exclude-all-symbols
2897Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2898[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2899
252b5132
RH
2900@kindex --file-alignment
2901@item --file-alignment
2902Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2903file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2904512.
bb10df36 2905[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2906
2907@cindex heap size
2908@kindex --heap
2909@item --heap @var{reserve}
2910@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 2911Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 2912to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 2913committed.
bb10df36 2914[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2915
2916@cindex image base
2917@kindex --image-base
2918@item --image-base @var{value}
2919Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
2920the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
2921is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
2922your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
2923other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
2924for dlls.
bb10df36 2925[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2926
2927@kindex --kill-at
2928@item --kill-at
2929If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
2930symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 2931[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2932
26d2d8a2
BF
2933@kindex --large-address-aware
2934@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 2935If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 2936header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 2937greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
2938or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
2939section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
2940[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2941
f69a2f97
NC
2942@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
2943@item --disable-large-address-aware
2944Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
2945This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
2946driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
2947addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
2948[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2949
252b5132
RH
2950@kindex --major-image-version
2951@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2952Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 2953[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2954
2955@kindex --major-os-version
2956@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2957Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2958[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2959
2960@kindex --major-subsystem-version
2961@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2962Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2963[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2964
2965@kindex --minor-image-version
2966@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2967Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2968[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2969
2970@kindex --minor-os-version
2971@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2972Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2973[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2974
2975@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
2976@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2977Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2978[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2979
2980@cindex DEF files, creating
2981@cindex DLLs, creating
2982@kindex --output-def
2983@item --output-def @var{file}
2984The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
2985file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
2986(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
2987library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
2988automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 2989[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2990
b044cda1 2991@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
2992@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
2993@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
2994@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
2995Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
2996@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
2997By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
2998for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
2999execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3000[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3001
3002@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3003@item --disable-auto-image-base
3004Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3005user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3006default.
bb10df36 3007[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3008
3009@cindex DLLs, linking to
3010@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3011@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3012When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3013search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3014@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3015between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3016uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3017@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3018[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3019
3020@kindex --enable-auto-import
3021@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3022Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3023DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3024mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3025[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3026
3027The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3028feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3029
3030Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3031of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3032PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3033
e2a83dd0
NC
3034Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3035data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3036placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3037around a problem with consts that is described here:
3038http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3039
4d8907ac
DS
3040Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3041see this message:
0d888aac 3042
ece2d90e 3043"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3044documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3045
ece2d90e
NC
3046This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3047ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3048allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3049fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3050constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3051multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3052this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3053of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3054the warning, and exit.
3055
3056There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3057data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3058
2fa9fc65
NC
3059One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3060of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3061this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3062
c0065db7
RM
3063A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3064that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3065there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3066a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3067
3068@example
3069extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3070extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3071 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3072@end example
3073
3074or
3075
3076@example
3077extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3078extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3079 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3080@end example
3081
c0065db7 3082For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3083is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3084
3085@example
3086extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3087extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3088 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3089@end example
3090
c406afaf
NC
3091or
3092
3093@example
3094extern long long extern_ll;
3095extern_ll -->
3096 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3097@end example
3098
2fa9fc65 3099A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3100'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3101@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3102requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3103building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3104merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3105between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3106constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3107
3108Original:
3109@example
3110--foo.h
3111extern int arr[];
3112--foo.c
3113#include "foo.h"
3114void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3115 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3116@}
3117@end example
3118
3119Solution 1:
3120@example
3121--foo.h
3122extern int arr[];
3123--foo.c
3124#include "foo.h"
3125void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3126 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3127 volatile int *parr = arr;
3128 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3129@}
3130@end example
3131
3132Solution 2:
3133@example
3134--foo.h
3135/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3136#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3137 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3138#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3139#else
3140#define FOO_IMPORT
3141#endif
3142extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3143--foo.c
3144#include "foo.h"
3145void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3146 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3147@}
3148@end example
3149
c0065db7 3150A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3151library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3152for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3153functions).
b044cda1
CW
3154
3155@kindex --disable-auto-import
3156@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3157Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3158@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3159[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3160
2fa9fc65
NC
3161@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3162@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3163If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3164that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3165a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3166environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3167[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3168
3169@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3170@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3171Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3172[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3173
b044cda1
CW
3174@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3175@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3176Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3177[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3178
252b5132
RH
3179@kindex --section-alignment
3180@item --section-alignment
3181Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3182addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3183[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3184
3185@cindex stack size
3186@kindex --stack
3187@item --stack @var{reserve}
3188@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3189Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3190to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3191committed.
bb10df36 3192[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3193
3194@kindex --subsystem
3195@item --subsystem @var{which}
3196@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3197@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3198Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3199legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3200@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3201the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3202@var{which}.
bb10df36 3203[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3204
2f563b51
DK
3205The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3206of the PE file header:
3207[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3208
2d5c3743
NC
3209@kindex --high-entropy-va
3210@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3211@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3212Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3213(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3214
dc9bd8c9
HD
3215This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3216@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3217
2f563b51
DK
3218@kindex --dynamicbase
3219@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3220@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3221The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3222randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3223Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3224can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3225This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3226
3227@kindex --forceinteg
3228@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3229@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3230Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3231default.
2f563b51
DK
3232
3233@kindex --nxcompat
3234@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3235@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3236The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3237This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3238targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3239
3240@kindex --no-isolation
3241@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3242@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3243Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3244This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3245
3246@kindex --no-seh
3247@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3248@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3249The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3250this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3251
3252@kindex --no-bind
3253@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3254@itemx --disable-no-bind
3255Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3256
3257@kindex --wdmdriver
3258@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3259@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3260The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3261by default.
9d5777a3 3262
2f563b51
DK
3263@kindex --tsaware
3264@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3265@itemx --disable-tsaware
3266The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3267default.
2f563b51 3268
0cb112f7
CF
3269@kindex --insert-timestamp
3270@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3271@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3272Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3273as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3274other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3275will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3276same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3277can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3278that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3279identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3280
3281@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3282@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3283@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3284Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3285is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3286This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3287@end table
3288
0285c67d
NC
3289@c man end
3290
ac145307
BS
3291@ifset C6X
3292@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3293
3294@c man begin OPTIONS
3295
3296The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3297libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3298all executables use an index of 0.
3299
3300@table @gcctabopt
3301
3302@kindex --dsbt-size
3303@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3304This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3305or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3306entries.
3307
3308@kindex --dsbt-index
3309@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3310This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3311to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3312executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3313@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3314
fbd9ad90
PB
3315@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3316The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3317exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3318
ac145307
BS
3319@end table
3320
3321@c man end
3322@end ifset
3323
b8891f8d
AJ
3324@ifset CSKY
3325@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3326
3327@c man begin OPTIONS
3328
3329@table @gcctabopt
3330
3331@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3332@item --branch-stub
3333This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3334sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3335usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3336can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3337the compiler or assembler.
3338
3339@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3340@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3341This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3342It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3343be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3344stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3345sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3346@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3347linker should choose suitable defaults.
3348
3349@end table
3350
3351@c man end
3352@end ifset
3353
93fd0973
SC
3354@ifset M68HC11
3355@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3356
3357@c man begin OPTIONS
3358
3359The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3360memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3361
3362@table @gcctabopt
3363
3364@kindex --no-trampoline
3365@item --no-trampoline
3366This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3367is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3368instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3369
3370@kindex --bank-window
3371@item --bank-window @var{name}
3372This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3373the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3374The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3375paging and addresses within the memory window.
3376
3377@end table
3378
3379@c man end
3380@end ifset
3381
7fb9f789
NC
3382@ifset M68K
3383@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3384
3385@c man begin OPTIONS
3386
3387The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3388when linking for 68K targets.
3389
3390@table @gcctabopt
3391
3392@kindex --got
3393@item --got=@var{type}
3394This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3395@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3396@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3397Info entry for @file{ld}.
3398
3399@end table
3400
3401@c man end
3402@end ifset
3403
833794fc
MR
3404@ifset MIPS
3405@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3406
3407@c man begin OPTIONS
3408
3409The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3410generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3411linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3412
3413@table @gcctabopt
3414
3415@kindex --insn32
3416@item --insn32
3417@kindex --no-insn32
3418@itemx --no-insn32
3419These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3420generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3421or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
342232-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3423used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3424possible.
3425
8b10b0b3
MR
3426@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3427@item --ignore-branch-isa
3428@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3429@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3430These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3431transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3432accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3433is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3434instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3435equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3436calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3437a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3438an error.
3439
3734320d
MF
3440@kindex --compact-branches
3441@item --compact-branches
3442@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3443@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3444These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3445in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3446
833794fc
MR
3447@end table
3448
3449@c man end
3450@end ifset
3451
fa1477dc
SC
3452
3453@ifset PDP11
3454@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3455
3456@c man begin OPTIONS
3457
3458For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3459produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3460for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3461targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3462defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3463here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3464
3465@table @gcctabopt
3466
3467@kindex -N
3468@item -N
3469@kindex --omagic
3470@itemx --omagic
3471
3472Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3473indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3474shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3475writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3476the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3477programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3478from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3479
3480@kindex -n
3481@item -n
3482@kindex --nmagic
3483@itemx --nmagic
3484
3485Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3486indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3487be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3488file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3489byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3490a @emph{pure executable} format.
3491
3492@kindex -z
3493@item -z
3494@kindex --imagic
3495@itemx --imagic
3496
3497Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3498indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3499data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3500instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3501larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3502to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3503shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3504option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3505and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3506this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3507executable} format.
3508
3509@kindex --no-omagic
3510@item --no-omagic
3511
3512Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3513
3514@end table
3515
3516@c man end
3517@end ifset
3518
252b5132
RH
3519@ifset UsesEnvVars
3520@node Environment
3521@section Environment Variables
3522
0285c67d
NC
3523@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3524
560e09e9 3525You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3526@ifclear SingleFormat
3527@code{GNUTARGET},
3528@end ifclear
3529@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3530
36f63dca 3531@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3532@kindex GNUTARGET
3533@cindex default input format
3534@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3535use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3536of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3537@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3538of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3539attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3540this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3541there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3542object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3543BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3544in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3545@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3546
3547@kindex LDEMULATION
3548@cindex default emulation
3549@cindex emulation, default
3550@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3551@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3552behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3553available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3554the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3555variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3556linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3557
3558@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3559@cindex demangling, default
3560Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3561@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3562default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3563a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3564may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3565options.
3566
0285c67d
NC
3567@c man end
3568@end ifset
3569
252b5132
RH
3570@node Scripts
3571@chapter Linker Scripts
3572
3573@cindex scripts
3574@cindex linker scripts
3575@cindex command files
3576Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3577written in the linker command language.
3578
3579The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3580the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3581the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3582more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3583direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3584described below.
3585
3586The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3587yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3588linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3589to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3590such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3591
3592You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3593line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3594default linker script.
3595
3596You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3597to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3598Linker Scripts}.
3599
3600@menu
3601* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3602* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3603* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3604* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3605* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3606* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3607* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3608* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3609* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3610* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3611* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3612@end menu
3613
3614@node Basic Script Concepts
3615@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3616@cindex linker script concepts
3617We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3618describe the linker script language.
3619
3620The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3621file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3622@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3623The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3624purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3625among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3626section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3627in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3628
3629Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3630also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3631contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3632the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3633A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3634area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3635loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3636which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3637of debugging information.
3638
3639Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3640first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3641the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3642@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3643section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3644same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3645is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3646(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3647based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3648RAM address would be the VMA.
3649
3650You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3651program with the @samp{-h} option.
3652
3653Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3654@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3655has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3656information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3657will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3658static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3659referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3660
3661You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3662program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3663option.
3664
3665@node Script Format
3666@section Linker Script Format
3667@cindex linker script format
3668Linker scripts are text files.
3669
3670You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3671either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3672symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3673generally ignored.
3674
3675Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3676If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3677otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3678double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3679file name.
3680
3681You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3682@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3683to whitespace.
3684
3685@node Simple Example
3686@section Simple Linker Script Example
3687@cindex linker script example
3688@cindex example of linker script
3689Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3690
3691The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3692@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3693memory layout of the output file.
3694
3695The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3696describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3697code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3698@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3699Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3700your input files.
3701
3702For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
37030x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3704linker script which will do that:
3705@smallexample
3706SECTIONS
3707@{
3708 . = 0x10000;
3709 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3710 . = 0x8000000;
3711 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3712 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3713@}
3714@end smallexample
3715
3716You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3717followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3718descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3719
252b5132
RH
3720The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3721sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3722counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3723other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3724current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3725incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3726@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3727
3728The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3729required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3730after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3731which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3732wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3733means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3734
3735Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3736@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3737@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3738
3739The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3740the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3741at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3742output section, the value of the location counter will be
3743@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3744effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3745immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3746
3747The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3748alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3749example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3750sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3751may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3752sections.
3753
3754That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3755
3756@node Simple Commands
3757@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3758@cindex linker script simple commands
3759In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3760
3761@menu
3762* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3763* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3764@ifclear SingleFormat
3765* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3766@end ifclear
3767
4a93e180 3768* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3769* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3770@end menu
3771
3772@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3773@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3774@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3775@cindex start of execution
3776@cindex first instruction
3777@cindex entry point
3778The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3779point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3780entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3781@smallexample
3782ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3783@end smallexample
3784
3785There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3786entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3787stopping when one of them succeeds:
3788@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3789@item
252b5132 3790the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3791@item
252b5132 3792the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3793@item
a094d01f 3794the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3795targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3796check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3797@item
252b5132 3798the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
a1ab1d2a 3799@item
252b5132
RH
3800The address @code{0}.
3801@end itemize
3802
3803@node File Commands
36f63dca 3804@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3805@cindex linker script file commands
3806Several linker script commands deal with files.
3807
3808@table @code
3809@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3810@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3811@cindex including a linker script
3812Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3813be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3814with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
381510 levels deep.
3816
4006703d
NS
3817You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3818@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3819
252b5132
RH
3820@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3821@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3822@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3823@cindex input files in linker scripts
3824@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3825@cindex linker script input object files
3826The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3827in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3828
3829For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3830a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3831then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3832
3833In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3834script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3835
e3f2db7f
AO
3836In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3837with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3838located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3839for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3840@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3841filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3842@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3843
3844If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3845the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3846found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3847not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3848path.
252b5132 3849
ff5dcc92 3850If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3851name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3852@samp{-l}.
3853
3854When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3855files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3856script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3857
3858@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3859@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3860@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3861@cindex grouping input files
3862The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3863files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3864new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3865in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3866
b717d30e
JJ
3867@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3868@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3869@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3870This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3871commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3872as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3873with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3874when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3875@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3876and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3877setting afterwards.
3878
252b5132
RH
3879@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3880@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 3881@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
3882The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3883@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3884@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 3885Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
3886precedence.
3887
3888You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3889output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3890
3891@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3892@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3893@cindex library search path in linker script
3894@cindex archive search path in linker script
3895@cindex search path in linker script
3896The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 3897@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 3898@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 3899on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 3900are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 3901the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
3902
3903@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3904@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3905@cindex first input file
3906The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3907that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3908though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3909when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3910first file.
3911@end table
3912
3913@ifclear SingleFormat
3914@node Format Commands
36f63dca 3915@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
3916A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3917
3918@table @code
3919@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3920@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
3921@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3922@cindex output file format in linker script
3923The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
3924output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 3925exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3926(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
3927line option takes precedence.
3928
3929You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 3930formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
3931This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
3932desired endianness.
3933
3934If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
3935will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
3936output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
3937used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
3938
3939For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
3940command:
3941@smallexample
3942OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
3943@end smallexample
3944This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 3945@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
3946option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
3947format.
3948
3949@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3950@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3951@cindex input file format in linker script
3952The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
3953files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
3954This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3955(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
3956is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
3957command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
3958@end table
3959@end ifclear
3960
4a93e180
NC
3961@node REGION_ALIAS
3962@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
3963@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3964@cindex region alias
3965@cindex region names
3966
3967Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
3968@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
3969
3970@smallexample
3971REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3972@end smallexample
3973
3974The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
3975memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
3976to memory regions. An example follows.
3977
3978Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
3979memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
3980that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
3981non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
3982access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
3983read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
3984sections:
3985
3986@itemize @bullet
3987@item
3988@code{.text} program code;
3989@item
3990@code{.rodata} read-only data;
3991@item
3992@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
3993@item
3994@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
3995@end itemize
3996
3997The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
3998part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
3999output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4000systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4001@code{C}:
4002@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4003@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4004@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4005@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4006@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4007@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4008@end multitable
4009The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4010loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4011the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4012the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4013
4014The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4015includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4016memory layout:
4017@smallexample
4018INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4019
4020SECTIONS
4021 @{
4022 .text :
4023 @{
4024 *(.text)
4025 @} > REGION_TEXT
4026 .rodata :
4027 @{
4028 *(.rodata)
4029 rodata_end = .;
4030 @} > REGION_RODATA
4031 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4032 @{
4033 data_start = .;
4034 *(.data)
4035 @} > REGION_DATA
4036 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4037 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4038 .bss :
4039 @{
4040 *(.bss)
4041 @} > REGION_BSS
4042 @}
4043@end smallexample
4044
4045Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4046regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4047variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4048@table @code
4049@item A
4050Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4051@smallexample
4052MEMORY
4053 @{
4054 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4055 @}
4056
4057REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4058REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4059REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4060REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4061@end smallexample
4062@item B
4063Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4064into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4065@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4066@smallexample
4067MEMORY
4068 @{
4069 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4070 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4071 @}
4072
4073REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4074REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4075REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4076REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4077@end smallexample
4078@item C
4079Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4080@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4081initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4082system start into the @code{RAM}.
4083@smallexample
4084MEMORY
4085 @{
4086 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4087 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4088 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4089 @}
4090
4091REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4092REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4093REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4094REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4095@end smallexample
4096@end table
4097
4098It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4099@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4100necessary:
4101@smallexample
4102#include <string.h>
4103
4104extern char data_start [];
4105extern char data_size [];
4106extern char data_load_start [];
4107
4108void copy_data(void)
4109@{
4110 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4111 @{
4112 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4113 @}
4114@}
4115@end smallexample
4116
252b5132 4117@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4118@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4119There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4120
4121@table @code
4122@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4123@kindex ASSERT
4124@cindex assertion in linker script
4125Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4126with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4127
fd1c4238
NC
4128Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4129take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4130inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4131for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4132symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4133
4134@smallexample
4135 .stack :
4136 @{
4137 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4138 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4139 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4140 @}
4141@end smallexample
4142
4143will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4144PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4145can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4146
4147@smallexample
4148 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4149 .stack :
4150 @{
4151 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4152 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4153 @}
4154@end smallexample
4155
4156will work.
4157
252b5132
RH
4158@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4159@kindex EXTERN
4160@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4161Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4162symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4163modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4164each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4165command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4166
4167@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4168@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4169@cindex common allocation in linker script
4170This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4171to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4172output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4173
4818e05f
AM
4174@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4175@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4176@cindex common allocation in linker script
4177This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4178command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4179to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4180
7bdf4127
AB
4181@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4182@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4183@cindex group allocation in linker script
4184@cindex section groups
4185@cindex COMDAT
4186This command has the same effect as the
4187@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4188@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4189and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4190specified (@samp{-r}).
4191
53d25da6
AM
4192@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4193@kindex INSERT
4194@cindex insert user script into default script
4195This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4196augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4197inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4198@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4199default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4200sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4201linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4202insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4203linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4204default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4205of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4206to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4207is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4208
4209@smallexample
4210SECTIONS
4211@{
4212 OVERLAY :
4213 @{
4214 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4215 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4216 @}
4217@}
4218INSERT AFTER .text;
4219@end smallexample
4220
252b5132
RH
4221@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4222@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4223@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4224This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4225references among certain output sections.
4226
4227In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4228using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4229will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4230errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4231a function defined in the other section.
4232
4233The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4234@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4235an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4236@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4237names.
4238
cdf96953
MF
4239@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4240@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4241@cindex cross references
4242This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4243references to one section from a list of other sections.
4244
4245The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4246output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4247a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4248there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4249must never call back.
4250
4251The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4252The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4253If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4254the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4255status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4256names, not input section names.
4257
252b5132
RH
4258@ifclear SingleFormat
4259@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4260@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4261@cindex machine architecture
4262@cindex architecture
4263Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4264of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4265architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4266the @samp{-f} option.
4267@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4268
4269@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4270@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4271This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4272@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4273in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4274@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4275@end table
4276
4277@node Assignments
4278@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4279@cindex assignment in scripts
4280@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4281@cindex variables, defining
4282You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4283the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4284
4285@menu
4286* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4287* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4288* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4289* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4290* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4291@end menu
4292
4293@node Simple Assignments
4294@subsection Simple Assignments
4295
4296You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4297
4298@table @code
4299@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4300@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4301@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4302@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4303@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4304@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4305@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4306@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4307@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4308@end table
4309
4310The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4311@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4312defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4313
4314The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4315may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4316
4317The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4318
4319Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4320
4321You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4322statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4323section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4324
4325The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4326expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4327
4328Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4329assignments may be used:
4330
4331@smallexample
4332floating_point = 0;
4333SECTIONS
4334@{
4335 .text :
4336 @{
4337 *(.text)
4338 _etext = .;
4339 @}
156e34dd 4340 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4341 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4342@}
4343@end smallexample
4344@noindent
4345In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4346zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4347the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4348defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4349upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4350
eb8476a6
MR
4351@node HIDDEN
4352@subsection HIDDEN
4353@cindex HIDDEN
4354For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4355exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4356
4357Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4358@code{HIDDEN}:
4359
4360@smallexample
4361HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4362SECTIONS
4363@{
4364 .text :
4365 @{
4366 *(.text)
4367 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4368 @}
4369 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4370 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4371@}
4372@end smallexample
4373@noindent
4374In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4375
252b5132
RH
4376@node PROVIDE
4377@subsection PROVIDE
4378@cindex PROVIDE
4379In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4380only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4381the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4382@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4383@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4384@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4385@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4386@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4387
4388Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4389@smallexample
4390SECTIONS
4391@{
4392 .text :
4393 @{
4394 *(.text)
4395 _etext = .;
4396 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4397 @}
4398@}
4399@end smallexample
4400
4401In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4402underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition error. If, on
4403the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4404underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4405If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4406linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4407
b0daac83
NC
4408Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4409defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4410that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4411when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4412@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4413
7af8e998
L
4414@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4415@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4416@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4417Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4418hidden and won't be exported.
4419
73ae6183
NC
4420@node Source Code Reference
4421@subsection Source Code Reference
4422
4423Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4424intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4425a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4426symbol that does not have a value.
4427
4428Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4429transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4430stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4431prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4432mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4433of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4434variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4435linker script variable might be referred to as:
4436
4437@smallexample
4438 extern int foo;
4439@end smallexample
4440
4441But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4442
4443@smallexample
4444 _foo = 1000;
4445@end smallexample
4446
4447In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4448transformation has taken place.
4449
4450When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4451things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4452in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4453second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4454table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4455contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4456value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4457
4458@smallexample
4459 int foo = 1000;
4460@end smallexample
4461
10bf6894 4462creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4463holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4464number 1000 is initially stored.
4465
4466When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4467first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4468memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4469So:
4470
4471@smallexample
4472 foo = 1;
4473@end smallexample
4474
4475looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4476associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4477address. Whereas:
4478
4479@smallexample
4480 int * a = & foo;
4481@end smallexample
4482
10bf6894 4483looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4484and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4485the variable @samp{a}.
4486
4487Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4488the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4489an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4490
4491@smallexample
4492 foo = 1000;
4493@end smallexample
4494
4495creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4496the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4497address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4498linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4499access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4500
4501Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4502you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4503use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4504section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4505linker script contains these declarations:
4506
4507@smallexample
4508@group
4509 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4510 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4511 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4512@end group
4513@end smallexample
4514
4515Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4516
4517@smallexample
4518@group
4519 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4520
73ae6183
NC
4521 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4522@end group
4523@end smallexample
4524
4525Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4526Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4527arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4528
4529@smallexample
4530@group
4531 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4532
4533 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4534@end group
4535@end smallexample
4536
4537Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4538operators.
73ae6183 4539
252b5132 4540@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4541@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4542@kindex SECTIONS
4543The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4544into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4545
4546The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4547@smallexample
4548SECTIONS
4549@{
4550 @var{sections-command}
4551 @var{sections-command}
4552 @dots{}
4553@}
4554@end smallexample
4555
4556Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4557
4558@itemize @bullet
4559@item
4560an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4561@item
4562a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4563@item
4564an output section description
4565@item
4566an overlay description
4567@end itemize
4568
4569The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4570@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4571those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4572understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4573the layout of the output file.
4574
4575Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4576below.
4577
4578If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4579linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4580section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4581input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4582example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4583in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4584
4585@menu
4586* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4587* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4588* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4589* Input Section:: Input section description
4590* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4591* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4592* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4593* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4594* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4595@end menu
4596
4597@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4598@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4599The full description of an output section looks like this:
4600@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4601@group
7e7d5768 4602@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4603 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4604 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4605 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4606 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4607 @{
4608 @var{output-section-command}
4609 @var{output-section-command}
4610 @dots{}
abc9061b 4611 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4612@end group
4613@end smallexample
4614
4615Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4616
4617The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4618name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4619The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4620the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4621The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4622
4623Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4624
4625@itemize @bullet
4626@item
4627a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4628@item
4629an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4630@item
4631data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4632@item
4633a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4634@end itemize
4635
4636@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4637@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4638@cindex name, section
4639@cindex section name
4640The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4641meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4642support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4643must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4644example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4645output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4646names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4647quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4648characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4649commas must be quoted.
4650
4651The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4652Discarding}.
4653
4654@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4655@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4656@cindex address, section
4657@cindex section address
4658The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4659address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4660is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4661
4662If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4663section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4664to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4665alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4666contained within the output section.
4667
4668The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4669
4670@itemize @bullet
4671@item
4672If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4673is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4674in that region.
4675
4676@item
4677If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4678regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4679section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4680be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4681
4682@item
4683If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4684the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4685counter.
4686@end itemize
4687
4688@noindent
4689For example:
4690
252b5132
RH
4691@smallexample
4692.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4693@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4694
252b5132
RH
4695@noindent
4696and
ea5cae92 4697
252b5132
RH
4698@smallexample
4699.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4700@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4701
252b5132
RH
4702@noindent
4703are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4704@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4705counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4706counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4707input sections.
252b5132
RH
4708
4709The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4710For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4711so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4712do something like this:
4713@smallexample
4714.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4715@end smallexample
4716@noindent
4717This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4718aligned upward to the specified value.
4719
4720Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4721location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4722sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4723
4724@node Input Section
36f63dca 4725@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4726@cindex input sections
4727@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4728The most common output section command is an input section description.
4729
4730The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4731You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4732in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4733map the input files into your memory layout.
4734
4735@menu
4736* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4737* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4738* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4739* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4740* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4741@end menu
4742
4743@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4744@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4745@cindex input section basics
4746An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4747by a list of section names in parentheses.
4748
4749The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4750describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4751
4752The most common input section description is to include all input
4753sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4754include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4755@smallexample
4756*(.text)
4757@end smallexample
4758@noindent
18625d54 4759Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4760@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4761of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4762match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4763example:
252b5132 4764@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4765EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4766@end smallexample
4767@noindent
4768will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4769and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4770placed inside the section list, for example:
4771@smallexample
b4346c09 4772*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4773@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4774@noindent
4775The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4776two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4777more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4778
4779There are two ways to include more than one section:
4780@smallexample
4781*(.text .rdata)
4782*(.text) *(.rdata)
4783@end smallexample
4784@noindent
4785The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4786@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4787first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4788they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4789@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4790@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4791
8f1732fc
AB
4792When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4793is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4794immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4795@smallexample
4796*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4797@end smallexample
4798@noindent
4799will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4800@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4801from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4802exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4803could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4804@smallexample
4805*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4806@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4807@noindent
4808Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4809before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4810all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4811@smallexample
4812EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4813@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4814
252b5132
RH
4815You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4816You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4817needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4818@smallexample
4819data.o(.data)
4820@end smallexample
4821
ae17ab41
CM
4822To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4823of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4824
4825Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4826
4827@smallexample
4828@group
4829SECTIONS @{
4830 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4831 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4832@}
4833@end group
4834@end smallexample
4835
4836In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4837input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4838@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4839@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4840whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4841
967928e9
AM
4842You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4843matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4844with no whitespace around the colon.
4845
4846@table @samp
4847@item archive:file
4848matches file within archive
4849@item archive:
4850matches the whole archive
4851@item :file
4852matches file but not one in an archive
4853@end table
4854
4855Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4856wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4857single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4858@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4859within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4860also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4861other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4862from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4863command.
4864
252b5132
RH
4865If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4866the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4867commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4868@smallexample
4869data.o
4870@end smallexample
4871
967928e9
AM
4872When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4873and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
4874characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4875name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4876did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4877though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4878@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4879the archive search path.
4880
4881@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 4882@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
4883@cindex input section wildcards
4884@cindex wildcard file name patterns
4885@cindex file name wildcard patterns
4886@cindex section name wildcard patterns
4887In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4888name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4889
4890The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4891pattern for the file name.
4892
4893The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4894
4895@table @samp
4896@item *
4897matches any number of characters
4898@item ?
4899matches any single character
4900@item [@var{chars}]
4901matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4902character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4903@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4904@item \
4905quotes the following character
4906@end table
4907
4908When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4909will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4910Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4911exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4912@samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4913a @samp{/} character.
4914
4915File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4916specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4917does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4918
4919If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
4920appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
4921will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
4922sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
4923@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
4924@smallexample
4925.data : @{ *(.data) @}
4926.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
4927@end smallexample
4928
bcaa7b3e 4929@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
4930Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
4931in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
4932this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
4933pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
4934@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
4935into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
4936
bcaa7b3e 4937@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
4938@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4939@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
4940alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
4941alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
4942needed.
bcaa7b3e 4943
02ecc8e9 4944@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
4945@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4946@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
4947numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
4948section name before placing them in the output file. In
4949@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
4950the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
4951@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 4952
bcaa7b3e
L
4953@cindex SORT
4954@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4955
4956When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
4957can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
4958
4959@enumerate
4960@item
4961@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4962It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4963sections have the same name.
4964@item
4965@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4966It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4967sections have the same alignment.
4968@item
c0065db7 4969@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
4970treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
4971@item
4972@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
4973is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
4974@item
4975All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
4976@end enumerate
4977
a05a5b64 4978When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 4979section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 4980takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
4981
4982If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 4983command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
4984treated as nested sorting command.
4985
4986@enumerate
4987@item
4988@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
4989@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
4990@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
4991@item
4992@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
4993@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
4994@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
4995@end enumerate
4996
4997If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 4998command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 4999
eda680f8 5000@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5001@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5002section sorting option.
5003
252b5132
RH
5004If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5005@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5006precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5007
5008This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5009files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5010sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5011The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5012with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5013linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5014@smallexample
5015@group
5016SECTIONS @{
5017 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5018 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5019 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5020 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5021@}
5022@end group
5023@end smallexample
5024
5025@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5026@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5027@cindex common symbol placement
5028@cindex uninitialized data placement
5029A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5030file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5031linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5032named @samp{COMMON}.
5033
5034You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5035other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5036particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5037input files are placed in another section.
5038
5039In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5040@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5041@smallexample
5042.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5043@end smallexample
5044
5045@cindex scommon section
5046@cindex small common symbols
5047Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5048example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5049symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5050different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5051the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5052symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5053to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5054locations.
5055
5056@cindex [COMMON]
5057You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5058notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5059@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5060
5061@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5062@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5063@cindex KEEP
5064@cindex garbage collection
5065When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5066it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5067This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5068with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5069@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5070
5071@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5072@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5073The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5074to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5075start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5076@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5077follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5078@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5079@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5080All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5081files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5082
5083@smallexample
5084@group
5085SECTIONS @{
5086 outputa 0x10000 :
5087 @{
5088 all.o
5089 foo.o (.input1)
5090 @}
36f63dca
NC
5091@end group
5092@group
252b5132
RH
5093 outputb :
5094 @{
5095 foo.o (.input2)
5096 foo1.o (.input1)
5097 @}
36f63dca
NC
5098@end group
5099@group
252b5132
RH
5100 outputc :
5101 @{
5102 *(.input1)
5103 *(.input2)
5104 @}
5105@}
5106@end group
a1ab1d2a 5107@end smallexample
252b5132 5108
cbd0eecf
L
5109If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5110and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5111automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5112__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5113indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5114respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5115C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5116
252b5132 5117@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5118@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5119@cindex data
5120@cindex section data
5121@cindex output section data
5122@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5123@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5124@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5125@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5126@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5127You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5128@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5129an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5130parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5131value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5132counter.
5133
5134The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5135store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5136bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5137stored.
5138
5139For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5140of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5141@smallexample
5142BYTE(1)
5143LONG(addr)
5144@end smallexample
5145
5146When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5147same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5148target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5149@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5150@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5151
5152If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5153which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5154When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5155true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5156endianness of the first input object file.
5157
36f63dca 5158Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5159between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5160@smallexample
5161SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5162@end smallexample
5163whereas this will work:
5164@smallexample
5165SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5166@end smallexample
5167
252b5132
RH
5168@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5169@cindex holes, filling
5170@cindex unspecified memory
5171You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5172current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5173otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5174gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5175with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5176necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5177point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5178than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5179different parts of an output section.
5180
5181This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5182value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5183@smallexample
563e308f 5184FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5185@end smallexample
5186
5187The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5188section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5189part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5190entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5191precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5192expression.
252b5132
RH
5193
5194@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5195@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5196There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5197commands.
5198
5199@table @code
5200@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5201@cindex input filename symbols
5202@cindex filename symbols
5203@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5204The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5205The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5206file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5207the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5208
5209This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5210normally used for any other object file format.
5211
5212@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5213@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5214@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5215@item CONSTRUCTORS
5216When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5217unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5218destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5219arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5220automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5221For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5222linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5223@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5224ignored for other object file formats.
5225
5226The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5227constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5228Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5229the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5230first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5231of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5232compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5233formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5234@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5235the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5236destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5237@code{exit}.
5238
5239For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5240arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5241addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5242and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5243linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5244runtime code expects to see.
5245
5246@smallexample
5247 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5248 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5249 *(.ctors)
5250 LONG(0)
5251 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5252 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5253 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5254 *(.dtors)
5255 LONG(0)
5256 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5257@end smallexample
5258
5259If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5260which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5261are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5262are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5263command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5264@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5265@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5266@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5267
5268Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5269and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5270need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5271scripts.
5272
5273@end table
5274
5275@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5276@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5277@cindex discarding sections
5278@cindex sections, discarding
5279@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5280The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5281This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5282may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5283@smallexample
49c13adb 5284.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5285@end smallexample
5286@noindent
5287will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5288@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5289sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5290space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5291too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5292space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5293@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5294@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5295This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5296
a0976ea4 5297The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5298on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5299symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5300the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5301section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5302
5303@cindex /DISCARD/
5304The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5305input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5306section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5307
99fabbc9
JL
5308This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5309@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5310garbage collection.
5311
a2e098c3
NC
5312Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5313discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5314members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5315Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5316
252b5132 5317@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5318@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5319@cindex output section attributes
5320We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5321like this:
0c71d759 5322
252b5132 5323@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5324@group
7e7d5768 5325@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5326 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5327 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5328 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5329 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5330 @{
5331 @var{output-section-command}
5332 @var{output-section-command}
5333 @dots{}
562d3460 5334 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5335@end group
5336@end smallexample
0c71d759 5337
252b5132
RH
5338We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5339@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5340remaining section attributes.
5341
a1ab1d2a 5342@menu
252b5132
RH
5343* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5344* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5345* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5346* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5347* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5348* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5349* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5350* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5351@end menu
5352
5353@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5354@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5355Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5356parentheses. The following types are defined:
5357
5358@table @code
5359@item NOLOAD
5360The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5361loaded into memory when the program is run.
5362@item DSECT
5363@itemx COPY
5364@itemx INFO
5365@itemx OVERLAY
5366These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5367rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5368marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5369section when the program is run.
5370@end table
5371
5372@kindex NOLOAD
5373@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5374@cindex loading, preventing
5375The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5376the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5377the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5378@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5379need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5380@smallexample
5381@group
5382SECTIONS @{
5383 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5384 @dots{}
5385@}
5386@end group
5387@end smallexample
5388
5389@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5390@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5391@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5392@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5393@cindex load address
5394@cindex section load address
5395Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5396@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5397@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5398specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5399address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5400
ea5cae92
NC
5401The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5402specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5403takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5404load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5405region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5406
5407If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5408section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5409load address:
5410
5411@itemize @bullet
5412@item
5413If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5414the LMA address as well.
5415
5416@item
5417If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5418
5419@item
5420Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5421with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5422section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5423VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5424the last section in the located region.
5425
5426@item
5427If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5428that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5429
5430@item
5431If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5432section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5433@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5434
5435@cindex ROM initialized data
5436@cindex initialized data in ROM
5437This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5438example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5439called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5440@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5441even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5442uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5443defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5444counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5445
5446@smallexample
5447@group
5448SECTIONS
5449 @{
5450 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5451 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5452 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5453 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5454 .bss 0x3000 :
5455 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5456@}
5457@end group
5458@end smallexample
5459
5460The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5461this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5462the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5463how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5464script.
5465
5466@smallexample
5467@group
5468extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5469char *src = &_etext;
5470char *dst = &_data;
5471
ea5cae92
NC
5472/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5473while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5474 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5475
ea5cae92 5476/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5477for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5478 *dst = 0;
5479@end group
5480@end smallexample
5481
bbf115d3
L
5482@node Forced Output Alignment
5483@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5484@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5485@cindex forcing output section alignment
5486@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5487You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5488alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5489intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5490
7e7d5768
AM
5491@node Forced Input Alignment
5492@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5493@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5494@cindex forcing input section alignment
5495@cindex input section alignment
5496You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5497SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5498sections, whether larger or smaller.
5499
0c71d759
NC
5500@node Output Section Constraint
5501@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5502@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5503@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5504@cindex constraints on output sections
5505You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5506of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5507read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5508@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5509
252b5132 5510@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5511@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5512@kindex >@var{region}
5513@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5514@cindex memory regions and sections
5515You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5516using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5517
5518Here is a simple example:
5519@smallexample
5520@group
5521MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5522SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5523@end group
5524@end smallexample
5525
5526@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5527@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5528@kindex :@var{phdr}
5529@cindex section, assigning to program header
5530@cindex program headers and sections
5531You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5532using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5533one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5534assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5535@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5536linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5537
5538Here is a simple example:
5539@smallexample
5540@group
5541PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5542SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5543@end group
5544@end smallexample
5545
5546@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5547@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5548@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5549@cindex section fill pattern
5550@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5551You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5552@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5553(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5554within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5555alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5556necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5557of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5558an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5559fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5560other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5561pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5562expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5563
5564You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5565output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5566
5567Here is a simple example:
5568@smallexample
5569@group
563e308f 5570SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5571@end group
5572@end smallexample
5573
5574@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5575@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5576@kindex OVERLAY
5577@cindex overlays
5578An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5579are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5580the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5581copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5582required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5583can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5584than another.
5585
5586Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5587@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5588output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5589command is as follows:
5590@smallexample
5591@group
5592OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5593 @{
5594 @var{secname1}
5595 @{
5596 @var{output-section-command}
5597 @var{output-section-command}
5598 @dots{}
5599 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5600 @var{secname2}
5601 @{
5602 @var{output-section-command}
5603 @var{output-section-command}
5604 @dots{}
5605 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5606 @dots{}
abc9061b 5607 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5608@end group
5609@end smallexample
5610
5611Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5612section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5613section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5614those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5615except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5616sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5617
abc9061b
CC
5618The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5619the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5620
252b5132
RH
5621The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5622addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5623memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5624whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5625and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5626and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5627
56dd11f0
NC
5628If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5629references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5630the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5631sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5632@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5633
5634For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5635provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5636defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5637@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5638the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5639within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5640symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5641
5642At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5643the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5644
5645Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5646@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5647@smallexample
5648@group
5649 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5650 @{
5651 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5652 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5653 @}
5654@end group
5655@end smallexample
5656@noindent
5657This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5658address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5659@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5660following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5661@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5662@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5663
5664C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5665like the following.
5666
5667@smallexample
5668@group
5669 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5670 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5671 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5672@end group
5673@end smallexample
5674
5675Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5676everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5677example could have been written identically as follows.
5678
5679@smallexample
5680@group
5681 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5682 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5683 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5684 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5685 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5686 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5687 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5688@end group
5689@end smallexample
5690
5691@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5692@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5693@kindex MEMORY
5694@cindex memory regions
5695@cindex regions of memory
5696@cindex allocating memory
5697@cindex discontinuous memory
5698The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5699memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5700
5701The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5702memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5703may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5704can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5705set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5706regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5707around to fit into the available regions.
5708
127fcdff
AB
5709A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5710however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5711specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5712@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5713@smallexample
5714@group
a1ab1d2a 5715MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5716 @{
5717 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5718 @dots{}
5719 @}
5720@end group
5721@end smallexample
5722
5723The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5724region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5725Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5726with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5727must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5728add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5729command.
252b5132
RH
5730
5731@cindex memory region attributes
5732The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5733whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5734not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5735@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5736section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5737the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5738them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5739
5740The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5741@table @samp
5742@item R
5743Read-only section
5744@item W
5745Read/write section
5746@item X
5747Executable section
5748@item A
5749Allocatable section
5750@item I
5751Initialized section
5752@item L
5753Same as @samp{I}
5754@item !
c09e9a8c 5755Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5756@end table
5757
81c688d5 5758If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5759@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5760attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5761unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5762not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5763string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5764or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5765the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5766
5767@kindex ORIGIN =
5768@kindex o =
5769@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5770The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5771the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5772cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5773abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5774@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5775
5776@kindex LENGTH =
5777@kindex len =
5778@kindex l =
5779The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5780region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5781be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5782@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5783
5784In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5785available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5786and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5787linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5788is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5789or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5790explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5791region.
5792
5793@smallexample
5794@group
a1ab1d2a 5795MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5796 @{
5797 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5798 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5799 @}
5800@end group
5801@end smallexample
5802
5803Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5804specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5805@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5806a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5807output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5808was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5809the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5810output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5811region, the linker will issue an error message.
5812
3ec57632 5813It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5814expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5815@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5816
5817@smallexample
5818@group
c0065db7 5819 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5820@end group
5821@end smallexample
5822
252b5132
RH
5823@node PHDRS
5824@section PHDRS Command
5825@kindex PHDRS
5826@cindex program headers
5827@cindex ELF program headers
5828@cindex program segments
5829@cindex segments, ELF
5830The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5831@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5832loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5833program with the @samp{-p} option.
5834
5835When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5836reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5837program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5838This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5839interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5840
5841The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5842in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5843precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5844the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5845not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5846
5847The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5848generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5849ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5850
5851This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5852@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5853
5854@smallexample
5855@group
5856PHDRS
5857@{
5858 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5859 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5860@}
5861@end group
5862@end smallexample
5863
5864The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5865of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5866header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5867with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5868must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5869is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5870
5871Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5872system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5873specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5874sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5875attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5876Section Phdr}.
5877
5878It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5879merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5880repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5881contain the section.
5882
5883If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5884then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5885not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5886convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5887placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5888default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5889segment at all.
5890
5891@kindex FILEHDR
5892@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 5893You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
5894the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5895The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5896file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 5897include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
5898segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5899these keywords.
252b5132
RH
5900
5901The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5902value of the keyword.
5903
5904@table @asis
5905@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5906Indicates an unused program header.
5907
5908@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5909Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5910the file.
5911
5912@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5913Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5914
5915@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5916Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5917found.
5918
5919@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
5920Indicates a segment holding note information.
5921
5922@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
5923A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
5924ABI.
5925
5926@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
5927Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
5928
1a9ccd70
NC
5929@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
5930Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
5931
252b5132
RH
5932@item @var{expression}
5933An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
5934be used for types not defined above.
5935@end table
5936
5937You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
5938in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
5939@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
5940Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
5941output section attribute.
5942
5943The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
5944which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
5945explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
5946an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
5947header.
5948
5949Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
5950headers used on a native ELF system.
5951
5952@example
5953@group
5954PHDRS
5955@{
5956 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
5957 interp PT_INTERP ;
5958 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
5959 data PT_LOAD ;
5960 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
5961@}
5962
5963SECTIONS
5964@{
5965 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
5966 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
5967 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
5968 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
5969 @dots{}
5970 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
5971 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
5972 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
5973 @dots{}
5974@}
5975@end group
5976@end example
5977
5978@node VERSION
5979@section VERSION Command
5980@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
5981@cindex symbol versions
5982@cindex version script
5983@cindex versions of symbols
5984The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
5985only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
5986symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
5987a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
5988shared library.
5989
5990You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
5991you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
5992also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
5993
5994The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
5995@smallexample
5996VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
5997@end smallexample
5998
5999The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6000Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6001version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6002version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6003version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6004scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6005library.
6006
6007The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6008examples.
6009
6010@smallexample
6011VERS_1.1 @{
6012 global:
6013 foo1;
6014 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6015 old*;
6016 original*;
6017 new*;
252b5132
RH
6018@};
6019
6020VERS_1.2 @{
6021 foo2;
6022@} VERS_1.1;
6023
6024VERS_2.0 @{
6025 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6026 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6027 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6028 "f(int, double)";
6029 @};
252b5132
RH
6030@} VERS_1.2;
6031@end smallexample
6032
6033This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6034version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6035The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6036a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6037of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6038symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6039is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6040in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6041However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6042name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6043
6044Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6045depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6046to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6047
6048Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6049depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6050and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6051
6052When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6053specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6054unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6055unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6056somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6057wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6058wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6059set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6060ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6061
6062The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6063they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6064could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6065However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6066
0f6bf451 6067Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6068in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6069symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6070won't.
6071
6072@smallexample
7c9c73be 6073@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6074@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6075
252b5132
RH
6076When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6077symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6078requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6079shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6080loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6081linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6082application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6083way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6084all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6085search for each symbol reference.
6086
6087The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6088doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6089that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6090functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6091the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6092required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6093that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6094versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6095the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6096
6097There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6098first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6099source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6100script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6101maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6102@smallexample
6103__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6104@end smallexample
6105@noindent
6106in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6107be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6108The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6109@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6110takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6111
6112The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6113function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6114an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6115version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6116linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6117
6118To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6119source file. Here is an example:
6120
6121@smallexample
6122__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6123__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6124__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6125__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6126@end smallexample
6127
6128In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6129unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6130example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6131@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6132
6133When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6134some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6135this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6136@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6137declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6138you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6139
6140If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6141within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6142(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6143specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6144
cb840a31
L
6145You can also specify the language in the version script:
6146
6147@smallexample
6148VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6149@end smallexample
6150
c0065db7 6151The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6152The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6153demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6154patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6155@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6156
86043bbb
MM
6157Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6158described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6159or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6160the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6161whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6162cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6163might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6164should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6165expect when you upgrade.
6166
252b5132
RH
6167@node Expressions
6168@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6169@cindex expressions
6170@cindex arithmetic
6171The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6172that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6173expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6174host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6175
6176You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6177
6178The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6179expressions.
6180
6181@menu
6182* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6183* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6184* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6185* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6186* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6187* Operators:: Operators
6188* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6189* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6190* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6191@end menu
6192
6193@node Constants
6194@subsection Constants
6195@cindex integer notation
6196@cindex constants in linker scripts
6197All constants are integers.
6198
6199As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6200octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6201hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6202@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6203@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6204value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6205
6206@cindex scaled integers
6207@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6208@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6209@cindex suffixes for integers
6210@cindex integer suffixes
6211In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6212constant by
6213@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6214@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6215@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6216@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6217@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6218@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6219@tex
6220${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6221@end tex
6222@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6223respectively. For example, the following
6224all refer to the same quantity:
6225
252b5132 6226@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6227_fourk_1 = 4K;
6228_fourk_2 = 4096;
6229_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6230_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6231@end smallexample
6232
8a308ae8
NC
6233Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6234conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6235
0c71d759
NC
6236@node Symbolic Constants
6237@subsection Symbolic Constants
6238@cindex symbolic constants
6239@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6240It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6241the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6242
6243@table @code
6244@item MAXPAGESIZE
6245@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6246The target's maximum page size.
6247
6248@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6249@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6250The target's default page size.
6251@end table
6252
6253So for example:
6254
6255@smallexample
9d5777a3 6256 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6257@end smallexample
6258
6259will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6260supported by the target.
6261
252b5132
RH
6262@node Symbols
6263@subsection Symbol Names
6264@cindex symbol names
6265@cindex names
6266@cindex quoted symbol names
6267@kindex "
6268Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6269and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6270Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6271specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6272keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6273@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6274"SECTION" = 9;
6275"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6276@end smallexample
6277
6278Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6279to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6280whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6281
ecca9871
L
6282@node Orphan Sections
6283@subsection Orphan Sections
6284@cindex orphan
6285Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6286are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6287script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6288output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6289in which to place the orphaned input section.
6290
6291If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6292an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6293placed at the end of that output section.
6294
6295If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6296sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6297name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6298orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6299one new output section.
6300
6301If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6302then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6303in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6304linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6305attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6306sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6307support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6308
a05a5b64
TP
6309The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6310(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6311output sections an orphan is placed in.
6312
252b5132
RH
6313@node Location Counter
6314@subsection The Location Counter
6315@kindex .
6316@cindex dot
6317@cindex location counter
6318@cindex current output location
6319The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6320current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6321location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6322within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6323anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6324
6325@cindex holes
6326Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6327moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6328location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6329and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6330doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6331
6332@smallexample
6333SECTIONS
6334@{
6335 output :
6336 @{
6337 file1(.text)
6338 . = . + 1000;
6339 file2(.text)
6340 . += 1000;
6341 file3(.text)
563e308f 6342 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6343@}
6344@end smallexample
6345@noindent
6346In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6347located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6348followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6349@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6350@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6351specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6352
5c6bbab8
NC
6353@cindex dot inside sections
6354Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6355current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6356statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6357absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6358however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6359not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6360
6361@smallexample
6362SECTIONS
6363@{
6364 . = 0x100
6365 .text: @{
6366 *(.text)
6367 . = 0x200
6368 @}
6369 . = 0x500
6370 .data: @{
6371 *(.data)
6372 . += 0x600
6373 @}
6374@}
6375@end smallexample
6376
6377The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6378and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6379the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6380much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6381move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6382and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6383the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6384the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6385
b5666f2f
AM
6386@cindex dot outside sections
6387Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6388output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6389needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6390
6391@smallexample
6392SECTIONS
6393@{
6394 start_of_text = . ;
6395 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6396 end_of_text = . ;
6397
6398 start_of_data = . ;
6399 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6400 end_of_data = . ;
6401@}
6402@end smallexample
6403
6404If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6405not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6406between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6407should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6408blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6409the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6410sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6411statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6412special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6413place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6414as follows:
6415
6416@smallexample
6417SECTIONS
6418@{
6419 start_of_text = . ;
6420 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6421 end_of_text = . ;
6422
6423 start_of_data = . ;
6424 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6425 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6426 end_of_data = . ;
6427@}
6428@end smallexample
6429
6430This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6431@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6432placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6433assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6434a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6435section. So you could write:
6436
6437@smallexample
6438SECTIONS
6439@{
6440 start_of_text = . ;
6441 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6442 end_of_text = . ;
6443
6444 . = . ;
6445 start_of_data = . ;
6446 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6447 end_of_data = . ;
6448@}
6449@end smallexample
6450
6451Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6452@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6453
252b5132
RH
6454@need 2000
6455@node Operators
6456@subsection Operators
6457@cindex operators for arithmetic
6458@cindex arithmetic operators
6459@cindex precedence in expressions
6460The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6461the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6462@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6463@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6464@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6465@smallexample
6466precedence associativity Operators Notes
6467(highest)
64681 left ! - ~ (1)
64692 left * / %
64703 left + -
64714 left >> <<
64725 left == != > < <= >=
64736 left &
64747 left |
64758 left &&
64769 left ||
647710 right ? :
647811 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6479(lowest)
6480@end smallexample
6481Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6482(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6483(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6484@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6485@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6486@tex
6487\vskip \baselineskip
6488%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6489\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6490\hrule
6491\halign
6492{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6493height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6494&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6495height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6496\noalign{\hrule}
6497height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6498&highest&&&&&\cr
6499% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6500&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6501&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6502&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6503&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6504&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6505&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6506&7&&left&&|&\cr
6507&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6508&9&&left&&||&\cr
6509&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6510&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6511&lowest&&&&&\cr
6512height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6513\hrule}
6514@end tex
6515@iftex
6516{
6517@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6518@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6519@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6520}
6521@end iftex
6522@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6523
6524@node Evaluation
6525@subsection Evaluation
6526@cindex lazy evaluation
6527@cindex expression evaluation order
6528The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6529an expression when absolutely necessary.
6530
6531The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6532address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6533regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6534as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6535
6536However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6537until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6538other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6539for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6540
6541The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6542assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6543allocation.
6544
6545Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6546@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6547
6548If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6549available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6550following
6551@smallexample
6552@group
6553SECTIONS
6554 @{
a1ab1d2a 6555 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6556 @{ *(.text) @}
6557 @}
6558@end group
6559@end smallexample
6560@noindent
6561will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6562address}.
6563
6564@node Expression Section
6565@subsection The Section of an Expression
6566@cindex expression sections
6567@cindex absolute expressions
6568@cindex relative expressions
6569@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6570@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6571@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6572Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6573relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6574using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6575value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6576symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6577operations.
6578
abf4be64
AM
6579Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6580section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6581address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6582@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6583functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6584One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6585(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6586differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6587versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6588section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6589Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6590absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6591given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6592everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6593
6594In the following simple example,
252b5132 6595
7542af2a
AM
6596@smallexample
6597@group
6598SECTIONS
6599 @{
6600 . = 0x100;
6601 __executable_start = 0x100;
6602 .data :
6603 @{
6604 . = 0x10;
6605 __data_start = 0x10;
6606 *(.data)
6607 @}
6608 @dots{}
6609 @}
6610@end group
6611@end smallexample
252b5132 6612
7542af2a
AM
6613both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6614address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6615@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6616section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6617
5c3049d2
AM
6618For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6619addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6620
6621@itemize @bullet
6622@item
c05f749e
AM
6623Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6624operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6625absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6626@item
7542af2a
AM
6627Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6628relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6629and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6630@item
c05f749e
AM
6631Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6632in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6633address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6634before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6635@end itemize
6636
6637The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6638
6639@itemize @bullet
6640@item
6641An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6642@item
6643The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6644@item
9bc8bb33 6645The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6646relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6647(after above conversions) is also a number when
6648@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6649but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6650@item
6651The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6652relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6653section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6654@item
6655The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6656conversions) is an absolute address.
6657@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6658
6659You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6660to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6661create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6662section @samp{.data}:
6663@smallexample
6664SECTIONS
6665 @{
6666 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6667 @}
6668@end smallexample
6669@noindent
6670If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6671@samp{.data} section.
6672
7542af2a
AM
6673Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6674particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6675
252b5132
RH
6676@node Builtin Functions
6677@subsection Builtin Functions
6678@cindex functions in expressions
6679The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6680use in linker script expressions.
6681
6682@table @code
6683@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6684@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6685@cindex expression, absolute
6686Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6687of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6688value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6689normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6690
6691@item ADDR(@var{section})
6692@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6693@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6694Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6695script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6696the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6697@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6698@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6699the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6700@smallexample
6701@group
6702SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6703 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6704 @{
252b5132
RH
6705 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6706 @dots{}
6707 @}
6708 .output :
6709 @{
6710 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6711 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6712 @}
6713@dots{} @}
6714@end group
6715@end smallexample
6716
876f4090
NS
6717@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6718@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6719@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6720@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6721@cindex round up location counter
6722@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6723@cindex round up expression
6724@cindex align expression
6725Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6726to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6727doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6728arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6729expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6730equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6731
6732Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6733next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6734variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6735input sections:
252b5132
RH
6736@smallexample
6737@group
6738SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6739 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6740 *(.data)
6741 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6742 @}
6743@dots{} @}
6744@end group
6745@end smallexample
6746@noindent
6747The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6748a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6749a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6750of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6751
6752The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6753
362c1d1a
NS
6754@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6755@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6756@cindex section alignment
6757Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6758been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6759evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6760the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6761value in that section.
6762@smallexample
6763@group
6764SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6765 .output @{
6766 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6767 @dots{}
6768 @}
6769@dots{} @}
6770@end group
6771@end smallexample
6772
252b5132
RH
6773@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6774@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6775This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6776scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6777section.
6778
2d20f7bf
JJ
6779@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6780@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6781This is equivalent to either
6782@smallexample
6783(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6784@end smallexample
6785or
6786@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6787(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6788 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6789@end smallexample
6790@noindent
6791depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6792for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6793@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6794If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6795memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6796bytes in the on-disk file.
6797
6798This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6799any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6800@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6801be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6802running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6803that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6804page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6805
6806@noindent
6807Example:
6808@smallexample
6809 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6810@end smallexample
6811
6812@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6813@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6814This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6815evaluation purposes.
6816
6817@smallexample
6818 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6819@end smallexample
6820
a4f5ad88
JJ
6821@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6822@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6823This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6824@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6825When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6826does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6827@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6828argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6829script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6830@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6831padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6832section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6833
6834@smallexample
6835 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6836@end smallexample
6837
252b5132
RH
6838@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6839@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6840@cindex symbol defaults
6841Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6842defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6843return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6844default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6845shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6846the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6847existed, its value is preserved:
6848
6849@smallexample
6850@group
6851SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6852 .text : @{
6853 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6854 @dots{}
6855 @}
6856 @dots{}
6857@}
6858@end group
6859@end smallexample
6860
3ec57632
NC
6861@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6862@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6863Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6864
252b5132
RH
6865@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6866@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6867@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6868Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6869Section LMA}).
6870
2e53f7d6
NC
6871@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6872@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6873Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6874@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6875
252b5132
RH
6876@kindex MAX
6877@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6878Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6879
6880@kindex MIN
6881@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6882Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6883
6884@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6885@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6886@cindex unallocated address, next
6887Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6888This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6889use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6890output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6891
3ec57632
NC
6892@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6893@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6894Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6895
ba916c8a
MM
6896@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6897@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6898Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
6899value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6900@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6901will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6902can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 6903``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
6904name.
6905
252b5132
RH
6906@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6907@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6908@cindex section size
6909Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6910been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6911evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6912@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6913@smallexample
6914@group
6915SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6916 .output @{
6917 .start = . ;
6918 @dots{}
6919 .end = . ;
6920 @}
6921 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
6922 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
6923@dots{} @}
6924@end group
6925@end smallexample
6926
6927@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
6928@itemx sizeof_headers
6929@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
6930@cindex header size
6931Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
6932information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
6933this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
6934choose, to facilitate paging.
6935
6936@cindex not enough room for program headers
6937@cindex program headers, not enough room
6938When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
6939@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
6940number of program headers before it has determined all the section
6941addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
6942additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
6943room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
6944the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
6945script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
6946you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
6947command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
6948@end table
6949
6950@node Implicit Linker Scripts
6951@section Implicit Linker Scripts
6952@cindex implicit linker scripts
6953If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
6954an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
6955linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
6956linker will report an error.
6957
6958An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
6959
6960Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
6961assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
6962commands.
6963
6964Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
6965at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
6966read. This can affect archive searching.
6967
bf6d8037
HC
6968@node Plugins
6969@chapter Linker Plugins
6970
6971@cindex plugins
6972@cindex linker plugins
6973The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
6974For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
6975support is implemented with a linker plugin.
6976
6977Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
6978be added here later.
6979
6980@menu
6981* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
6982@end menu
6983
6984@node libdep Plugin
6985@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
6986@cindex static library dependencies
6987Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
6988just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
6989optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
6990within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
6991rose to ascendance.
6992
6993One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
6994multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
6995dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
6996library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
6997referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
6998link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
6999libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7000explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7001
7002The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7003to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7004plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7005dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7006and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7007command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7008utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7009being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7010archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7011
7012For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7013library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7014the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7015
7016@smallexample
7017-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7018@end smallexample
7019
252b5132
RH
7020@ifset GENERIC
7021@node Machine Dependent
7022@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7023
7024@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7025@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7026sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7027functionality are not listed.
7028
7029@menu
36f63dca
NC
7030@ifset H8300
7031* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7032@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7033@ifset M68HC11
7034* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7035@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7036@ifset ARM
7037* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7038@end ifset
7039@ifset HPPA
7040* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7041@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7042@ifset M68K
7043* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7044@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7045@ifset MIPS
7046* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7047@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7048@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7049* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7050@end ifset
2469cfa2 7051@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7052* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7053@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7054@ifset NDS32
7055* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7056@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7057@ifset NIOSII
7058* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7059@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7060@ifset POWERPC
7061* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7062@end ifset
7063@ifset POWERPC64
7064* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7065@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7066@ifset S/390
7067* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7068@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7069@ifset SPU
7070* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7071@end ifset
74459f0e 7072@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7073* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7074@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7075@ifset WIN32
7076* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7077@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7078@ifset XTENSA
7079* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7080@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7081@end menu
7082@end ifset
7083
252b5132
RH
7084@ifset H8300
7085@ifclear GENERIC
7086@raisesections
7087@end ifclear
7088
7089@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7090@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7091
7092@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7093For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7094you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7095
7096@table @emph
7097@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7098@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7099@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7100targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7101program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7102respectively.
7103
7104@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7105@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7106@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7107@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7108sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7109page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7110(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7111@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7112top page of memory).
1502569c 7113
81f5558e
NC
7114@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7115indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7116displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7117the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7118@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7119whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7120range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7121
1502569c 7122@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7123@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7124biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7125which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7126page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7127(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7128@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7129the top page of memory).
7130
7131@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7132@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
713332 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7134changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7135(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7136@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7137the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7138@end table
7139
7140@ifclear GENERIC
7141@lowersections
7142@end ifclear
7143@end ifset
7144
36f63dca 7145@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7146@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7147@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7148@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7149@node Renesas
7150@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7151
c2dcd04e
NC
7152@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7153H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7154options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7155@end ifset
7156@end ifclear
7157
36f63dca
NC
7158@ifset ARM
7159@ifclear GENERIC
7160@raisesections
7161@end ifclear
7162
93fd0973
SC
7163@ifset M68HC11
7164@ifclear GENERIC
7165@raisesections
7166@end ifclear
7167
7168@node M68HC11/68HC12
7169@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7170
7171@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7172
7173@subsection Linker Relaxation
7174
7175For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7176optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7177
7178@table @emph
7179@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7180@item relaxing address modes
7181@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7182targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7183program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7184respectively.
7185
7186@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7187transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7188page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7189
7190@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7191When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7192of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7193addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7194@code{bset} instructions.
7195
7196@end table
7197
7198@subsection Trampoline Generation
7199
7200@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7201@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7202For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7203call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7204will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7205trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7206case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7207point to the function trampoline.
7208
7209@ifclear GENERIC
7210@lowersections
7211@end ifclear
7212@end ifset
7213
36f63dca 7214@node ARM
3674e28a 7215@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7216
7217@cindex ARM interworking support
7218@kindex --support-old-code
7219For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7220between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7221been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7222line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7223libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7224option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7225given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7226which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7227the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7228non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7229
7230@cindex thumb entry point
7231@cindex entry point, thumb
7232@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7233The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7234@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7235But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7236branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7237executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7238
ce11ba6c
KT
7239@cindex PE import table prefixing
7240@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7241The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7242the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7243element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7244import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7245
e489d0ae
PB
7246@cindex BE8
7247@kindex --be8
7248The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7249executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7250objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7251option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7252little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7253
3674e28a
PB
7254@cindex TARGET1
7255@kindex --target1-rel
7256@kindex --target1-abs
7257The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7258@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7259or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7260and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7261
7262@cindex TARGET2
7263@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7264The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7265@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7266meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7267@table @samp
7268@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7269@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7270@item abs
7271@samp{R_ARM_ABS32} (arm*-*-symbianelf)
3674e28a
PB
7272@item got-rel
7273@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7274@end table
7275
319850b4
JB
7276@cindex FIX_V4BX
7277@kindex --fix-v4bx
7278The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7279specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7280interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7281also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7282
7283In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7284linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7285@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7286
7287In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7288relocations are ignored.
7289
845b51d6
PB
7290@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7291@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7292Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7293relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7294
7295@smallexample
7296TST rM, #1
7297MOVEQ PC, rM
7298BX Rn
7299@end smallexample
7300
7301This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7302and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7303condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7304
33bfe774
JB
7305@cindex USE_BLX
7306@kindex --use-blx
7307The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7308BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7309situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7310code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7311each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7312
7313This option is enabled implicitly for SymbianOS, so there is no need to
7314specify it if you are using that target.
7315
c6dd86c6
JB
7316@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7317@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7318The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7319bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7320instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7321to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7322the support code can read the intended values.
7323
7324The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7325intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7326and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7327intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7328full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7329you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7330
7331If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7332enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7333@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7334mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7335vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7336@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7337
7338If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7339potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7340such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7341first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7342instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7343the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7344are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7345
2de70689
MGD
7346@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7347@kindex --fix-arm1176
7348@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7349The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7350in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7351are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7352unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7353
9d5777a3 7354Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7355Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7356http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7357
a504d23a
LA
7358@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7359@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7360
7361The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7362workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7363the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7364off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7365the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7366core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7367integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7368VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7369
7370The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7371necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7372
7373The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7374@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7375STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7376linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7377@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7378
7379If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7380potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7381such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7382replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7383branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7384then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7385
7386The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7387the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7388
7389The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7390they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7391there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7392occurs.
7393
7394The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7395PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7396large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7397cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7398occurs.
7399
bf21ed78
MS
7400@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7401@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7402The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7403warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7404enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7405linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7406using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7407not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7408
7409@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7410@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7411The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7412warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7413@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7414linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7415using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7416
726150b7
NC
7417@cindex PIC_VENEER
7418@kindex --pic-veneer
7419The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7420ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7421is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7422@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7423
7424@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7425@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7426The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7427code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7428perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7429placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7430controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7431The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7432duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7433group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7434code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7435where they should be placed.
7436
7437The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7438@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7439placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7440branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7441placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7442value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7443exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7444A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7445linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7446from the input sections.
7447
7448The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7449@samp{N = +1}.
7450
1a51c1a4
NC
7451Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7452only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7453otherwise.
7454
1db37fe6
YG
7455@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7456@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7457@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7458The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7459
7460The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7461
68fcca92
JW
7462@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7463@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7464@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7465The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7466
7467Please contact ARM for further details.
7468
1db37fe6
YG
7469@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7470@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7471@cindex Merging exidx entries
7472The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7473
7474@kindex --long-plt
7475@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7476The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7477which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7478entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7479
1f56df9d
JW
7480@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7481@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7482The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7483link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7484
4ba2ef8f
TP
7485@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7486All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7487Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7488@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7489veneers in memory.
7490
54ddd295
TP
7491@kindex --cmse-implib
7492@cindex Secure gateway import library
7493The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7494specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7495secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7496executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7497
0955507f
TP
7498@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7499@cindex Input import library
7500The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7501must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7502given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7503in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7504@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7505library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7506library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7507for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7508specified.
7509
36f63dca
NC
7510@ifclear GENERIC
7511@lowersections
7512@end ifclear
7513@end ifset
7514
7515@ifset HPPA
7516@ifclear GENERIC
7517@raisesections
7518@end ifclear
7519
7520@node HPPA ELF32
7521@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7522@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7523@kindex --multi-subspace
7524When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7525import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7526The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7527stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7528multiple sub-spaces.
7529
7530@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7531@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7532Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7533stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7534@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7535sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7536a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7537the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7538conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7539prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7540A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7541branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7542@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7543@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7544detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7545positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7546
7547Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7548single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7549create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7550large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7551
7552@ifclear GENERIC
7553@lowersections
7554@end ifclear
7555@end ifset
7556
7fb9f789
NC
7557@ifset M68K
7558@ifclear GENERIC
7559@raisesections
7560@end ifclear
7561
7562@node M68K
7563@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7564
7565@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7566@kindex --got=@var{type}
7567The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7568The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7569@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7570the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7571@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7572entries only at non-negative offsets.
7573@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7574entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7575support such GOTs.
7576@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7577output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7578file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7579files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7580
7581@ifclear GENERIC
7582@lowersections
7583@end ifclear
7584@end ifset
7585
833794fc
MR
7586@ifset MIPS
7587@ifclear GENERIC
7588@raisesections
7589@end ifclear
7590
7591@node MIPS
7592@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7593
7594@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7595@kindex --insn32
7596@kindex --no-insn32
7597The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7598microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7599in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7600used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7601or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7602including 16-bit ones where possible.
7603
8b10b0b3
MR
7604@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7605@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7606@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7607The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7608control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7609@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7610relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7611calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7612relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7613instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7614or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7615the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7616
833794fc
MR
7617@ifclear GENERIC
7618@lowersections
7619@end ifclear
7620@end ifset
7621
36f63dca
NC
7622@ifset MMIX
7623@ifclear GENERIC
7624@raisesections
7625@end ifclear
7626
7627@node MMIX
7628@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7629For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7630@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7631understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7632can translate between the two formats.
7633
7634There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7635Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7636registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7637equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7638@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7639global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7640this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7641symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7642
7a2de473
HPN
7643Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7644@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7645The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7646of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7647
7648Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7649are left out from an mmo file.
7650
7651@ifclear GENERIC
7652@lowersections
7653@end ifclear
7654@end ifset
7655
7656@ifset MSP430
7657@ifclear GENERIC
7658@raisesections
7659@end ifclear
7660
7661@node MSP430
7662@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7663For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7664will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7665just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7666
7667@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7668The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7669
7670@table @code
7671@item @samp{.vectors}
7672Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7673
7674@item @samp{.bootloader}
7675Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7676in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7677
7678@item @samp{.infomem}
7679Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7680this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7681
c0065db7 7682@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7683This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7684in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7685
7686@item @samp{.noinit}
7687Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7688
c0065db7 7689The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7690@end table
7691
7ef3addb
JL
7692@table @option
7693@cindex MSP430 Options
7694@kindex --code-region
7695@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7696This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7697argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7698using this option.
7699
7700@kindex --data-region
7701@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7702This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7703[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7704for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7705
7706@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7707@item --disable-sec-transformation
7708Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7709and @code{--data-region} options.
7710This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7711wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7712not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7713@end table
7714
36f63dca
NC
7715@ifclear GENERIC
7716@lowersections
7717@end ifclear
7718@end ifset
7719
35c08157
KLC
7720@ifset NDS32
7721@ifclear GENERIC
7722@raisesections
7723@end ifclear
7724
7725@node NDS32
7726@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7727@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7728For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7729relaxes objects according to these options.
7730
7731@table @code
7732@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7733Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7734
7735@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7736Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7737
7738@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7739Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7740
7741@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7742Export the EX9 table after linking.
7743
7744@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7745Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7746
7747@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7748Update the existing EX9 table.
7749
7750@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7751Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7752
7753@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7754Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7755
7756@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7757Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7758
7759@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7760Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7761@end table
7762
7763@ifclear GENERIC
7764@lowersections
7765@end ifclear
7766@end ifset
7767
78058a5e
SL
7768@ifset NIOSII
7769@ifclear GENERIC
7770@raisesections
7771@end ifclear
7772
7773@node Nios II
7774@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7775@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7776@kindex --relax on Nios II
7777
7778Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7779transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7780which may result in @command{ld} giving
7781@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7782The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7783trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7784outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7785trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7786be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7787larger than 256MB.
7788
7789The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7790is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7791@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7792locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7793source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7794register as a temporary.
7795
7796Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7797relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7798option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7799
7800@ifclear GENERIC
7801@lowersections
7802@end ifclear
7803@end ifset
7804
2a60a7a8
AM
7805@ifset POWERPC
7806@ifclear GENERIC
7807@raisesections
7808@end ifclear
7809
7810@node PowerPC ELF32
7811@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7812@cindex PowerPC long branches
7813@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7814Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7815displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7816@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7817@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7818the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7819section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7820section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7821@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7822both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7823considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7824
7825@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7826@table @option
7827@cindex PowerPC PLT
7828@kindex --bss-plt
7829@item --bss-plt
7830Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7831generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7832the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7833writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7834@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7835PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7836compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7837BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7838
016687f8
AM
7839@kindex --secure-plt
7840@item --secure-plt
7841@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7842@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7843when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7844layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7845style BSS PLT.
7846
2a60a7a8
AM
7847@cindex PowerPC GOT
7848@kindex --sdata-got
7849@item --sdata-got
7850The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7851sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7852@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7853section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7854@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7855@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7856@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7857@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7858PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7859pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7860GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7861really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7862
7863@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7864@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7865@item --emit-stub-syms
7866This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7867symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7868
7869@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7870@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7871@item --no-tls-optimize
7872PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7873sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7874disable the optimization.
7875@end table
7876
7877@ifclear GENERIC
7878@lowersections
7879@end ifclear
7880@end ifset
7881
7882@ifset POWERPC64
7883@ifclear GENERIC
7884@raisesections
7885@end ifclear
7886
7887@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7888@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7889
7890@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7891@table @option
7892@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7893@kindex --stub-group-size
7894@item --stub-group-size
7895Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7896by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7897@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7898sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7899a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7900the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7901conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7902prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7903A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7904branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7905@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7906@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7907detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7908positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7909
7910Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7911single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7912create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7913large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7914
7915@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7916@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7917@item --emit-stub-syms
7918This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7919symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7920
7921@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
7922@kindex --dotsyms
7923@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
7924@item --dotsyms
7925@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
7926These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
7927in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
7928function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
7929code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
7930properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
7931to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
7932@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
7933dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
7934feature.
7935
7ae4ea7d
AM
7936@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
7937@kindex --save-restore-funcs
7938@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
7939@item --save-restore-funcs
7940@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
7941These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
7942provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
7943@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
7944function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
7945link.
7946
2a60a7a8
AM
7947@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
7948@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7949@item --no-tls-optimize
7950PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7951sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7952disable the optimization.
7953
7c9cf415
AM
7954@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
7955@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
7956@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
7957@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
7958@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
7959@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
7960@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 7961These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
7962stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
7963an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
7964@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
7965stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
7966generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
7967__tls_get_addr_opt.
7968Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
7969much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
7970an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
7971will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
7972@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
7973and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
7974this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
7975Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 7976@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 7977register saves.
7c9cf415 7978
2a60a7a8
AM
7979@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
7980@kindex --no-opd-optimize
7981@item --no-opd-optimize
7982PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
7983corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 7984the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
7985Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
7986
7987@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
7988@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
7989@item --non-overlapping-opd
7990Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
7991@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
7992the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
7993entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
7994
7995@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
7996@kindex --no-toc-optimize
7997@item --no-toc-optimize
7998PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
7999entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8000reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8001marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8002marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8003relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8004unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8005reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8006discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8007reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8008code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8009optimization.
8010
d882c988
AM
8011@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8012@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8013@item --no-inline-optimize
8014PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8015marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8016@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8017a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8018locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8019disables that optimization.
8020
2a60a7a8
AM
8021@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8022@kindex --no-multi-toc
8023@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8024If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8025@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8026where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8027entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8028total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8029grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8030TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8031calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8032help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
803364K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8034Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8035
8036@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8037@kindex --no-toc-sort
8038@item --no-toc-sort
8039By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8040happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8041placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8042with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8043referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8044@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8045results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8046off this feature.
8047
8048@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8049@kindex --plt-align
8050@kindex --no-plt-align
8051@item --plt-align
8052@itemx --no-plt-align
8053Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8054aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8055boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8056specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8057specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8058if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8059PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8060
8061@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8062@kindex --plt-static-chain
8063@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8064@item --plt-static-chain
8065@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8066Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8067chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8068chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8069
8070@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8071@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8072@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8073@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8074@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8075With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8076lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8077another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8078order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8079memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8080barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8081looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8082seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8083default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8084
8085@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8086@kindex --plt-localentry
8087@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8088@item --plt-localentry
8089@itemx --no-localentry
8090ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8091ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8092(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8093Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8094or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8095functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8096in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8097interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8098including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8099to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8100complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8101care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8102
8103@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8104@kindex --power10-stubs
8105@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8106@item --power10-stubs
8107@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8108When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8109relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8110linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8111for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8112power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8113power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8114allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8115@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8116auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8117@end table
8118
8119@ifclear GENERIC
8120@lowersections
8121@end ifclear
8122@end ifset
8123
b4cbbe8f
AK
8124@ifset S/390
8125@ifclear GENERIC
8126@raisesections
8127@end ifclear
8128
8129@node S/390 ELF
8130@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8131
8132@cindex S/390 ELF options
8133@table @option
8134
8135@cindex S/390
8136@kindex --s390-pgste
8137@item --s390-pgste
8138This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8139segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8140binaries marked that way.
8141@end table
8142
8143@ifclear GENERIC
8144@lowersections
8145@end ifclear
8146@end ifset
8147
49fa1e15
AM
8148@ifset SPU
8149@ifclear GENERIC
8150@raisesections
8151@end ifclear
8152
8153@node SPU ELF
8154@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8155
8156@cindex SPU ELF options
8157@table @option
8158
8159@cindex SPU plugins
8160@kindex --plugin
8161@item --plugin
8162This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8163
8164@cindex SPU overlays
8165@kindex --no-overlays
8166@item --no-overlays
8167Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8168regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8169@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8170turns off all this special overlay handling.
8171
8172@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8173@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8174@item --emit-stub-syms
8175This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8176symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8177
8178@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8179@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8180@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8181This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8182function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8183on calls to non-overlay regions.
8184
8185@cindex SPU local store size
8186@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8187@item --local-store=lo:hi
8188@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8189the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8190range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8191
c0065db7 8192@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8193@kindex --stack-analysis
8194@item --stack-analysis
8195SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8196unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8197under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8198@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8199@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8200determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8201for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8202for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8203for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8204find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8205and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8206under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8207dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8208is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8209and calls will be given.
8210
c0065db7 8211@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8212@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8213@item --emit-stack-syms
8214This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8215in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8216These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8217functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8218functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8219such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8220The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8221@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8222@end table
8223
8224@ifclear GENERIC
8225@lowersections
8226@end ifclear
8227@end ifset
8228
36f63dca
NC
8229@ifset TICOFF
8230@ifclear GENERIC
8231@raisesections
8232@end ifclear
8233
8234@node TI COFF
8235@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8236@cindex TI COFF versions
8237@kindex --format=@var{version}
8238The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8239TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8240also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8241format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8242header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8243
8244@ifclear GENERIC
8245@lowersections
8246@end ifclear
8247@end ifset
8248
2ca22b03
NC
8249@ifset WIN32
8250@ifclear GENERIC
8251@raisesections
8252@end ifclear
8253
8254@node WIN32
8255@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8256
c0065db7 8257This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8258See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8259command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8260
8261@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8262@cindex import libraries
8263@item import libraries
69da35b5 8264The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8265libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8266regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8267archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8268support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8269@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8270
c0065db7
RM
8271@item exporting DLL symbols
8272@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8273The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8274
8275@table @emph
8276@item using auto-export functionality
8277@cindex using auto-export functionality
8278By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8279which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8280
0a5d968e
NC
8281@itemize
8282@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8283@item --exclude-symbols
8284@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8285@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8286@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8287@end itemize
8288
09e2aba4
DK
8289When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8290(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8291symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8292often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8293private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8294options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8295exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8296final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8297
8298If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8299command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8300if either of the following are true:
8301
8302@itemize
8303@item A DEF file is used.
8304@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8305@end itemize
dc8465bf 8306
c0065db7
RM
8307@item using a DEF file
8308@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8309Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8310an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8311exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8312name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8313command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8314
8315@example
8316gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8317@end example
8318
0a5d968e
NC
8319Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8320@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8321
dc8465bf
NC
8322Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8323
8324@example
4b5bd4e7 8325LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8326
8327EXPORTS
8328foo
8329bar
8330_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8331another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8332var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8333doo = foo == foo2
8334eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8335@end example
dc8465bf 8336
7fcab871 8337This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8338symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8339alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8340by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8341@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8342@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8343export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8344in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8345symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8346
6b31ad16
DS
8347The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8348name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8349the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8350
b45619c0
NC
8351When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8352library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8353@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8354executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8355
8356With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8357specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8358non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8359
8360If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8361or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8362filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8363
4b5bd4e7
DS
8364The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8365
8366@example
8367EXPORTS
8368 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8369 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8370 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8371@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8372
8373Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8374@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8375@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8376@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8377Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8378@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8379string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8380
8381The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8382
8383@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8384will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8385by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8386linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8387library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8388
8389@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8390The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8391the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8392@code{*_imp__foo}).
8393
8394@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8395well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8396read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8397variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8398the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8399extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8400application will behave unexpectedly.
8401
8402@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8403it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8404symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8405API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8406the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8407
4b5bd4e7
DS
8408See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8409other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8410
8411@cindex creating a DEF file
8412While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8413with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8414
8415@item Using decorations
8416@cindex Using decorations
8417Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8418itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8419declared as:
8420
8421@example
8422__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8423__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8424@end example
8425
8426All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8427any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8428this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8429the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8430
8431Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8432decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8433instead:
8434
8435@example
8436__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8437__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8438@end example
8439
c0065db7
RM
8440This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8441when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8442variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8443code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8444of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8445omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8446@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8447information.
c0065db7 8448@end table
dc8465bf 8449
2ca22b03
NC
8450@cindex automatic data imports
8451@item automatic data imports
8452The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8453by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8454compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8455issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8456code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8457c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8458initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8459decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8460platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8461command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8462The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8463suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8464trigger the feature's use.
8465
c0065db7 8466auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8467additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8468
c0065db7 8469"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8470documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8471
c0065db7
RM
8472The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8473occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8474One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8475below.
8476
8477@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8478For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8479object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8480offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8481field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8482in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8483without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8484The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8485references.
8486
c0065db7
RM
8487The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8488be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8489themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8490runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8491compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8492support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8493run without error on an older system.
8494
c0065db7
RM
8495@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8496enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8497
8498@cindex direct linking to a dll
8499@item direct linking to a dll
8500The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8501including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8502libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8503traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8504libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8505function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8506though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8507storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8508tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8509large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8510
c0065db7 8511Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8512@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8513of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8514perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8515select the dll instead of an import library.
8516
2ca22b03 8517
69da35b5
NC
8518For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8519to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8520
8521@example
45e948fe
NC
8522libxxx.dll.a
8523xxx.dll.a
8524libxxx.a
8525xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8526libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8527cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8528libxxx.dll
8529xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8530@end example
8531
69da35b5
NC
8532before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8533
c0065db7
RM
8534(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8535where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8536@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8537file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8538@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8539
c0065db7
RM
8540Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8541@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8542was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8543various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8544could coexist on the same machine.
8545
2ca22b03
NC
8546The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8547applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8548libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8549
8550@example
8551bin/
8552 cygxxx.dll
8553lib/
8554 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8555 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8556@end example
8557
c0065db7
RM
8558Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8559done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8560
85611. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8562@example
8563gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8564@end example
2ca22b03 8565
69da35b5
NC
8566However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8567(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8568@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8569not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8570
2ca22b03
NC
85712. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8572directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8573should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8574making the app/dll.
8575
8576@example
8577ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8578@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8579
8580Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8581
8582@example
8583gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8584@end example
69da35b5
NC
8585
8586This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8587perfectly legal
8588
8589@example
8590bin/
8591 cygxxx-5.dll
8592lib/
c0065db7 8593 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8594@end example
8595
dc8465bf 8596Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8597even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8598@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8599
8600Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8601wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8602
86031. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8604work with auto-imported data.
8605
dc8465bf
NC
86062. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8607import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8608symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8609for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8610possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8611
45e948fe
NC
86123. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8613critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8614in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8615stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8616
69da35b5 8617So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8618true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8619a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8620binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8621massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8622requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8623will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8624
c0065db7 8625@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8626@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8627@item adding additional names
8628Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8629A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8630exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8631when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8632import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8633
c0065db7 8634@example
dc8465bf
NC
8635LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8636
8637EXPORTS
c0065db7 8638foo
dc8465bf 8639_foo = foo
c0065db7 8640@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8641
8642The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8643
8644Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8645source code using the "weak" attribute:
8646
c0065db7
RM
8647@example
8648void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8649void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8650@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8651
8652See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8653symbols.
8654
8655@item renaming symbols
8656Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8657kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8658@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8659DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8660created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8661
c0065db7 8662@example
dc8465bf
NC
8663LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8664
8665EXPORTS
8666_foo = foo
c0065db7 8667@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8668
8669The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8670@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8671@end table
dc8465bf 8672
0a5d968e 8673Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8674unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8675If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8676@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8677that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8678@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8679renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8680to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8681the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8682In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8683which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8684
8685@cindex weak externals
8686@item weak externals
8687The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8688weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8689defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8690are three variants of weak externals:
8691@itemize
8692@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8693called lazy externals.
8694@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8695This form is not presently implemented.
8696@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8697implemented.
8698@end itemize
8699As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8700are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8701uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8702
8703@cindex aligned common symbols
8704@item aligned common symbols
8705As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8706desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8707the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8708carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8709by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8710tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8711but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8712warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8713
2ca22b03
NC
8714@end table
8715
8716@ifclear GENERIC
8717@lowersections
8718@end ifclear
8719@end ifset
8720
e0001a05
NC
8721@ifset XTENSA
8722@ifclear GENERIC
8723@raisesections
8724@end ifclear
8725
8726@node Xtensa
8727@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8728
8729@cindex Xtensa processors
8730The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8731@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8732specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8733keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8734example, with the command:
8735
8736@smallexample
8737SECTIONS
8738@{
8739 .text : @{
8740 *(.literal .text)
8741 @}
8742@}
8743@end smallexample
8744
8745@noindent
8746@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8747and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8748literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8749interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8750group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8751files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8752and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8753
43cd72b9 8754@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8755@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8756Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8757provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8758is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8759literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8760will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8761location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8762the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8763unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8764@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8765range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8766
8767For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8768to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8769instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8770instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8771instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8772@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8773hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8774By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8775switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8776density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8777instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8778performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8779linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8780a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8781
8782The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8783control the linker:
8784
8785@cindex Xtensa options
8786@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8787@item --size-opt
8788When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8789more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8790no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8791alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8792preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8793
8794@item --abi-windowed
8795@itemx --abi-call0
8796Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8797PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8798because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8799conventions.
8800Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8801of the first input object.
8802A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8803or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8804@end table
e0001a05
NC
8805
8806@ifclear GENERIC
8807@lowersections
8808@end ifclear
8809@end ifset
8810
252b5132
RH
8811@ifclear SingleFormat
8812@node BFD
8813@chapter BFD
8814
8815@cindex back end
8816@cindex object file management
8817@cindex object formats available
8818@kindex objdump -i
8819The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8820These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8821object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8822format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8823it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8824associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8825object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8826(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8827list all the formats available for your configuration.
8828
8829@cindex BFD requirements
8830@cindex requirements for BFD
8831As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8832several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8833BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8834formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8835been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8836BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8837may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8838
8839One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8840mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8841useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8842conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8843
8844@menu
8845* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8846@end menu
8847
8848@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8849@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8850@cindex opening object files
8851@include bfdsumm.texi
8852@end ifclear
8853
8854@node Reporting Bugs
8855@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8856@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8857@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8858
ff5dcc92 8859Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8860
8861Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8862it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8863to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8864work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8865@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8866
8867In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8868information that enables us to fix the bug.
8869
8870@menu
8871* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8872* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8873@end menu
8874
8875@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8876@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8877@cindex bug criteria
8878
8879If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8880
8881@itemize @bullet
8882@cindex fatal signal
8883@cindex linker crash
8884@cindex crash of linker
8885@item
8886If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 8887@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
8888
8889@cindex error on valid input
8890@item
ff5dcc92 8891If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
8892
8893@cindex invalid input
8894@item
ff5dcc92 8895If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
8896may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8897object files are correct.
8898
8899@item
8900If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 8901improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
8902@end itemize
8903
8904@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 8905@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 8906@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 8907@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
8908
8909A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 8910products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
8911recommend you contact that organization first.
8912
8913You can find contact information for many support companies and
8914individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8915distribution.
8916
ad22bfe8 8917@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 8918Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
8919@value{BUGURL}.
8920@end ifset
252b5132
RH
8921
8922The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
8923@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
8924fact or leave it out, state it!
8925
8926Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
8927problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
8928assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
8929matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
8930the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
8931location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
8932were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
8933into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
8934specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 8935and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
8936
8937Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
8938the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
8939on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
8940
8941Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
8942bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
8943respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
8944You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
8945
8946To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
8947
8948@itemize @bullet
8949@item
ff5dcc92 8950The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
8951the @samp{--version} argument.
8952
8953Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 8954the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8955
8956@item
ff5dcc92 8957Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
8958patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
8959
8960@item
8961The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
8962version number.
8963
8964@item
ff5dcc92 8965What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
8966``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
8967
8968@item
8969The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
8970observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
8971list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
8972sufficient.
8973
8974If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
8975and then we might not encounter the bug.
8976
8977@item
8978A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
8979bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
8980provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
8981bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
8982state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
8983requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
8984we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
8985attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
8986
8987If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
8988@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
8989object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
8990@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
8991how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
8992
8993@item
8994A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
8995incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
8996
ff5dcc92 8997Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
8998will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
8999not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9000a chance to make a mistake.
9001
9002Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9003say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9004copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9005C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9006and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9007fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9008you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9009any conclusion from our observations.
9010
9011@item
ff5dcc92 9012If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9013diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9014@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9015If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9016context, not by line number.
9017
9018The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9019sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9020@end itemize
9021
9022Here are some things that are not necessary:
9023
9024@itemize @bullet
9025@item
9026A description of the envelope of the bug.
9027
9028Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9029which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9030changes will not affect it.
9031
9032This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9033will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9034with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9035We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9036
9037Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9038of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9039output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9040less time, and so on.
9041
9042However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9043report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9044
9045@item
9046A patch for the bug.
9047
9048A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9049the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9050a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9051to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9052
ff5dcc92 9053Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9054construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9055through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9056able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9057fixed.
9058
9059And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9060patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9061help us to understand.
9062
9063@item
9064A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9065
9066Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9067things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9068@end itemize
9069
9070@node MRI
9071@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9072@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9073To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9074linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9075alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9076described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9077simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9078@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9079linker commands; these commands are described here.
9080
9081In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9082file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9083features to make use of them.
9084
9085You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9086@samp{-c} command-line option.
9087
9088Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9089command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9090blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9091MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9092issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9093
9094Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9095
9096You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9097lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9098The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9099
9100@table @code
9101@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9102@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9103@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9104Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9105the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9106@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9107your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9108script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9109commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9110input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9111@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9112
9113@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9114@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9115Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9116in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9117
9118@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9119
9120@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9121@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9122Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9123@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9124
9125@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9126@item BASE @var{expression}
9127Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9128absolute addresses) in the output file.
9129
9130@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9131@item CHIP @var{expression}
9132@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9133This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9134
9135@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9136@item END
9137This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9138
9139@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9140@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9141Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9142language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9143
9144@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9145@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9146Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9147@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9148
9149The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9150same line, with no change in its effect.
9151
9152@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9153@item LOAD @var{filename}
9154@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9155Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9156same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9157command line.
9158
9159@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9160@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9161@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9162MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9163option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9164
9165@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9166@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9167@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9168Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9169order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9170script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9171sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9172file, in the order specified.
9173
9174@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9175@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9176@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9177@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9178Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9179@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9180
9181@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9182@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9183@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9184@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9185You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9186specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9187If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9188@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9189@end table
9190
793c5807
NC
9191@node GNU Free Documentation License
9192@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9193@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9194
370b66a1
CD
9195@node LD Index
9196@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9197
9198@printindex cp
9199
9200@tex
7ca01ed9 9201% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9202% meantime:
9203\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9204\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9205\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9206\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9207\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9208\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9209\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9210\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9211\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9212% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9213@end tex
9214
252b5132 9215@bye